Automatic date update in version.in
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "ui-out.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
49 #include "block.h"
50 #include "solib.h"
51 #include "solist.h"
52 #include "observable.h"
53 #include "memattr.h"
54 #include "ada-lang.h"
55 #include "top.h"
56 #include "valprint.h"
57 #include "jit.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdb_regex.h"
60 #include "probe.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62 #include "stack.h"
63 #include "ax-gdb.h"
64 #include "dummy-frame.h"
65 #include "interps.h"
66 #include "gdbsupport/format.h"
67 #include "thread-fsm.h"
68 #include "tid-parse.h"
69 #include "cli/cli-style.h"
70 #include "cli/cli-decode.h"
71
72 /* readline include files */
73 #include "readline/tilde.h"
74
75 /* readline defines this. */
76 #undef savestring
77
78 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
79 #include "extension.h"
80 #include <algorithm>
81 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
82 #include "gdbsupport/array-view.h"
83 #include "gdbsupport/gdb_optional.h"
84
85 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
86
87 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
88 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
89
90 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
91
92 static void
93 create_sals_from_location_default (struct event_location *location,
94 struct linespec_result *canonical,
95 enum bptype type_wanted);
96
97 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
98 struct linespec_result *,
99 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
100 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
101 enum bptype,
102 enum bpdisp, int, int,
103 int,
104 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
105 int, int, int, unsigned);
106
107 static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
108 (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
109 struct program_space *search_pspace);
110
111 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint
112 (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals);
113
114 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
115
116 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
117 enum bptype,
118 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
119 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
120 const struct symtab_and_line *);
121
122 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
123 static. */
124 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
125 struct symtab_and_line,
126 enum bptype,
127 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
128
129 static struct breakpoint *
130 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
131 enum bptype type,
132 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
133 int loc_enabled);
134
135 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
136
137 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
138 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
139 enum bptype bptype);
140
141 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
142 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
143 struct obj_section *, int);
144
145 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
146 struct bp_location *loc2);
147
148 static int breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
149 struct bp_location *loc2,
150 bool sw_hw_bps_match = false);
151
152 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
153 const struct address_space *aspace,
154 CORE_ADDR addr);
155
156 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
157 const address_space *,
158 CORE_ADDR, int);
159
160 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
161 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
162
163 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
164
165 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
166
167 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
168
169 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
170 enum bptype type,
171 int *other_type_used);
172
173 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
174 int count);
175
176 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
177
178 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
179
180 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
181 insert locations now. */
182 enum ugll_insert_mode
183 {
184 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
185 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
186 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
187 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
188 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
189 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
190 returns true on them.
191
192 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
193 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
194 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
195 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
196 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
197 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
198 the inferior. */
199 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
200
201 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
202 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
203 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
204
205 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
206 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
207 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
208 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
209 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
210 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
211 as no thread is running yet. */
212 UGLL_INSERT
213 };
214
215 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
216
217 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
218
219 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
220
221 static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
222
223 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
224
225 static bool is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
226
227 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
228 otherwise. */
229
230 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
231
232 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
233 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
234 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
235 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
236
237 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
238 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
239
240 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
241 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
242
243 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
244 breakpoints. */
245 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
246
247 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
248 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
249
250 /* Tracepoints set on probes. */
251 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
252
253 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
254 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
255
256 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
257 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
258 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
259 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
260 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
261 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
262
263 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
264 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
265 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
266 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
267 dprintf_style_gdb,
268 dprintf_style_call,
269 dprintf_style_agent,
270 NULL
271 };
272 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
273
274 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
275 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
276 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
277 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
278
279 static char *dprintf_function;
280
281 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
282 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
283 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
284 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
285 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
286 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
287 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
288
289 static char *dprintf_channel;
290
291 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
292 has disconnected. */
293 static bool disconnected_dprintf = true;
294
295 struct command_line *
296 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
297 {
298 return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
299 }
300
301 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
302 current breakpoint. */
303
304 static bool breakpoint_proceeded;
305
306 const char *
307 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
308 {
309 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
310 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
311 a breakpoint. */
312 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
313
314 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
315 }
316
317 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
318 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
319 if such is available. */
320 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
321
322 static void
323 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
324 struct cmd_list_element *c,
325 const char *value)
326 {
327 fprintf_filtered (file,
328 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
329 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
330 value);
331 }
332
333 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
334 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
335 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
336 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
337 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
338 static void
339 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
340 struct cmd_list_element *c,
341 const char *value)
342 {
343 fprintf_filtered (file,
344 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
345 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
346 value);
347 }
348
349 /* If true, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
350 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
351 If false, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
352 use hardware breakpoints. */
353 static bool automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
354 static void
355 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
356 struct cmd_list_element *c,
357 const char *value)
358 {
359 fprintf_filtered (file,
360 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
361 value);
362 }
363
364 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
365 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
366 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
367 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
368 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
369 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
370 processing user input. */
371 static bool always_inserted_mode = false;
372
373 static void
374 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
375 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
376 {
377 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
378 value);
379 }
380
381 /* See breakpoint.h. */
382
383 int
384 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
385 {
386 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
387 {
388 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
389 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
390 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
391 return 1;
392 }
393 else
394 {
395 if (always_inserted_mode)
396 {
397 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
398 are stopped. */
399 return 1;
400 }
401
402 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
403 if (inf->has_execution ()
404 && threads_are_executing (inf->process_target ()))
405 return 1;
406
407 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
408 stopped, we still have events to process. */
409 for (thread_info *tp : all_non_exited_threads ())
410 if (tp->resumed
411 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
412 return 1;
413 }
414 return 0;
415 }
416
417 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
418
419 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
420 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
421 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
422 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
423 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
424 condition_evaluation_auto,
425 condition_evaluation_host,
426 condition_evaluation_target,
427 NULL
428 };
429
430 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
431 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
432
433 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
434 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
435 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
436
437 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
438 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
439 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
440 evaluation mode. */
441
442 static const char *
443 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
444 {
445 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
446 {
447 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
448 return condition_evaluation_target;
449 else
450 return condition_evaluation_host;
451 }
452 else
453 return mode;
454 }
455
456 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
457
458 static const char *
459 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
460 {
461 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
462 }
463
464 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
465 otherwise. */
466
467 static int
468 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
469 {
470 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
471
472 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
473 }
474
475 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
476 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
477
478 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
479 static int overlay_events_enabled;
480
481 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
482 bool target_exact_watchpoints = false;
483
484 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
485 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
486 current breakpoint. */
487
488 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
489 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
490 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
491 B = TMP)
492
493 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
494
495 static struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
496
497 /* See breakpoint.h. */
498
499 breakpoint_range
500 all_breakpoints ()
501 {
502 return breakpoint_range (breakpoint_chain);
503 }
504
505 /* See breakpoint.h. */
506
507 breakpoint_safe_range
508 all_breakpoints_safe ()
509 {
510 return breakpoint_safe_range (all_breakpoints ());
511 }
512
513 /* See breakpoint.h. */
514
515 tracepoint_range
516 all_tracepoints ()
517 {
518 return tracepoint_range (breakpoint_chain);
519 }
520
521 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_is_less_than - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
522
523 static std::vector<bp_location *> bp_locations;
524
525 /* See breakpoint.h. */
526
527 const std::vector<bp_location *> &
528 all_bp_locations ()
529 {
530 return bp_locations;
531 }
532
533 /* Range to iterate over breakpoint locations at a given address. */
534
535 struct bp_locations_at_addr_range
536 {
537 using iterator = std::vector<bp_location *>::iterator;
538
539 bp_locations_at_addr_range (CORE_ADDR addr)
540 {
541 struct compare
542 {
543 bool operator() (const bp_location *loc, CORE_ADDR addr_) const
544 { return loc->address < addr_; }
545
546 bool operator() (CORE_ADDR addr_, const bp_location *loc) const
547 { return addr_ < loc->address; }
548 };
549
550 auto it_pair = std::equal_range (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (),
551 addr, compare ());
552
553 m_begin = it_pair.first;
554 m_end = it_pair.second;
555 }
556
557 iterator begin () const
558 { return m_begin; }
559
560 iterator end () const
561 { return m_end; }
562
563 private:
564 iterator m_begin;
565 iterator m_end;
566 };
567
568 /* Return a range to iterate over all breakpoint locations exactly at address
569 ADDR.
570
571 If it's needed to iterate multiple times on the same range, it's possible
572 to save the range in a local variable and use it multiple times:
573
574 auto range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (addr);
575
576 for (bp_location *loc : range)
577 // use loc
578
579 for (bp_location *loc : range)
580 // use loc
581
582 This saves a bit of time, as it avoids re-doing the binary searches to find
583 the range's boundaries. Just remember not to change the bp_locations vector
584 in the mean time, as it could make the range's iterators stale. */
585
586 static bp_locations_at_addr_range
587 all_bp_locations_at_addr (CORE_ADDR addr)
588 {
589 return bp_locations_at_addr_range (addr);
590 }
591
592 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
593 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
594 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
595 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
596 an address you need to read. */
597
598 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
599
600 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
601 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
602 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
603 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
604 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
605
606 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
607
608 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
609 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
610 reported by a target. */
611 static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations;
612
613 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
614
615 static int breakpoint_count;
616
617 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
618 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
619 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
620 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
621 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
622
623 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
624
625 static int tracepoint_count;
626
627 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
628 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
629 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
630
631 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
632
633 struct breakpoint *
634 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
635 void *user_data)
636 {
637 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
638 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
639 return b;
640
641 return nullptr;
642 }
643
644 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
645 static int
646 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
647 {
648 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
649 }
650
651 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
652
653 static void
654 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
655 {
656 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
657 breakpoint_count = num;
658 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
659 }
660
661 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
662 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
663 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
664
665 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
666 breakpoint made. */
667
668 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
669 {
670 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
671 }
672
673 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
674 breakpoint made. */
675
676 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
677 {
678 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
679 }
680
681 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
682
683 void
684 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
685 {
686 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
687 b->hit_count = 0;
688 }
689
690 \f
691 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
692 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
693
694 struct breakpoint *
695 get_breakpoint (int num)
696 {
697 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
698 if (b->number == num)
699 return b;
700
701 return nullptr;
702 }
703
704 \f
705
706 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
707 evaluating conditions on its side. */
708
709 static void
710 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
711 {
712 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
713 evaluating conditions and if the user has
714 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
715 side. */
716 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
717 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
718 return;
719
720 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
721 return;
722
723 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
724 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
725 }
726
727 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
728 evaluating conditions on its side. */
729
730 static void
731 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
732 {
733 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
734 evaluating conditions and if the user has
735 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
736 side. */
737 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
738 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
739
740 return;
741
742 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
743 return;
744
745 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
746 }
747
748 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
749 condition_evaluation_mode. */
750
751 static void
752 set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty,
753 struct cmd_list_element *c)
754 {
755 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
756
757 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
758 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
759 {
760 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
761 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
762 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
763 return;
764 }
765
766 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
767 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
768
769 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
770 settings was "auto". */
771 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
772
773 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
774 if (new_mode != old_mode)
775 {
776 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
777 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
778
779 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
780 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
781 */
782
783 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
784 {
785 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
786 target. */
787 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
788 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
789 }
790 else
791 {
792 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
793 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
794 target knows about. */
795 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
796 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
797 loc->needs_update = 1;
798 }
799
800 /* Do the update. */
801 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
802 }
803
804 return;
805 }
806
807 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
808 what "auto" is translating to. */
809
810 static void
811 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
812 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
813 {
814 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
815 fprintf_filtered (file,
816 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
817 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
818 value,
819 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
820 else
821 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
822 value);
823 }
824
825 /* Parse COND_STRING in the context of LOC and set as the condition
826 expression of LOC. BP_NUM is the number of LOC's owner, LOC_NUM is
827 the number of LOC within its owner. In case of parsing error, mark
828 LOC as DISABLED_BY_COND. In case of success, unset DISABLED_BY_COND. */
829
830 static void
831 set_breakpoint_location_condition (const char *cond_string, bp_location *loc,
832 int bp_num, int loc_num)
833 {
834 bool has_junk = false;
835 try
836 {
837 expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&cond_string, loc->address,
838 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
839 if (*cond_string != 0)
840 has_junk = true;
841 else
842 {
843 loc->cond = std::move (new_exp);
844 if (loc->disabled_by_cond && loc->enabled)
845 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at "
846 "location %d, enabling.\n"),
847 bp_num, loc_num);
848
849 loc->disabled_by_cond = false;
850 }
851 }
852 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
853 {
854 if (loc->enabled)
855 {
856 /* Warn if a user-enabled location is now becoming disabled-by-cond.
857 BP_NUM is 0 if the breakpoint is being defined for the first
858 time using the "break ... if ..." command, and non-zero if
859 already defined. */
860 if (bp_num != 0)
861 warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d.%d, "
862 "disabling:\n %s"), bp_num, loc_num, e.what ());
863 else
864 warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d, "
865 "disabling:\n %s"), loc_num, e.what ());
866 }
867
868 loc->disabled_by_cond = true;
869 }
870
871 if (has_junk)
872 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), cond_string);
873 }
874
875 void
876 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
877 int from_tty, bool force)
878 {
879 if (*exp == 0)
880 {
881 xfree (b->cond_string);
882 b->cond_string = nullptr;
883
884 if (is_watchpoint (b))
885 static_cast<watchpoint *> (b)->cond_exp.reset ();
886 else
887 {
888 int loc_num = 1;
889 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
890 {
891 loc->cond.reset ();
892 if (loc->disabled_by_cond && loc->enabled)
893 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at "
894 "location %d, enabling.\n"),
895 b->number, loc_num);
896 loc->disabled_by_cond = false;
897 loc_num++;
898
899 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
900 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
901 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
902 }
903 }
904
905 if (from_tty)
906 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
907 }
908 else
909 {
910 if (is_watchpoint (b))
911 {
912 innermost_block_tracker tracker;
913 const char *arg = exp;
914 expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
915 if (*arg != 0)
916 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
917 watchpoint *w = static_cast<watchpoint *> (b);
918 w->cond_exp = std::move (new_exp);
919 w->cond_exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
920 }
921 else
922 {
923 /* Parse and set condition expressions. We make two passes.
924 In the first, we parse the condition string to see if it
925 is valid in at least one location. If so, the condition
926 would be accepted. So we go ahead and set the locations'
927 conditions. In case no valid case is found, we throw
928 the error and the condition string will be rejected.
929 This two-pass approach is taken to avoid setting the
930 state of locations in case of a reject. */
931 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
932 {
933 try
934 {
935 const char *arg = exp;
936 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
937 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
938 if (*arg != 0)
939 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
940 break;
941 }
942 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
943 {
944 /* Condition string is invalid. If this happens to
945 be the last loc, abandon (if not forced) or continue
946 (if forced). */
947 if (loc->next == nullptr && !force)
948 throw;
949 }
950 }
951
952 /* If we reach here, the condition is valid at some locations. */
953 int loc_num = 1;
954 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
955 {
956 set_breakpoint_location_condition (exp, loc, b->number, loc_num);
957 loc_num++;
958 }
959 }
960
961 /* We know that the new condition parsed successfully. The
962 condition string of the breakpoint can be safely updated. */
963 xfree (b->cond_string);
964 b->cond_string = xstrdup (exp);
965 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
966 }
967 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
968
969 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
970 }
971
972 /* See breakpoint.h. */
973
974 void
975 set_breakpoint_condition (int bpnum, const char *exp, int from_tty,
976 bool force)
977 {
978 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
979 if (b->number == bpnum)
980 {
981 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
982 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
983 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
984 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
985 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
986
987 if (extlang != NULL)
988 {
989 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
990 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
991 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
992 }
993 set_breakpoint_condition (b, exp, from_tty, force);
994
995 if (is_breakpoint (b))
996 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
997
998 return;
999 }
1000
1001 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bpnum);
1002 }
1003
1004 /* The options for the "condition" command. */
1005
1006 struct condition_command_opts
1007 {
1008 /* For "-force". */
1009 bool force_condition = false;
1010 };
1011
1012 static const gdb::option::option_def condition_command_option_defs[] = {
1013
1014 gdb::option::flag_option_def<condition_command_opts> {
1015 "force",
1016 [] (condition_command_opts *opts) { return &opts->force_condition; },
1017 N_("Set the condition even if it is invalid for all current locations."),
1018 },
1019
1020 };
1021
1022 /* Create an option_def_group for the "condition" options, with
1023 CC_OPTS as context. */
1024
1025 static inline gdb::option::option_def_group
1026 make_condition_command_options_def_group (condition_command_opts *cc_opts)
1027 {
1028 return {{condition_command_option_defs}, cc_opts};
1029 }
1030
1031 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
1032
1033 static void
1034 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
1035 completion_tracker &tracker,
1036 const char *text, const char * /*word*/)
1037 {
1038 bool has_no_arguments = (*text == '\0');
1039 condition_command_opts cc_opts;
1040 const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts);
1041 if (gdb::option::complete_options
1042 (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group))
1043 return;
1044
1045 text = skip_spaces (text);
1046 const char *space = skip_to_space (text);
1047 if (*space == '\0')
1048 {
1049 int len;
1050
1051 if (text[0] == '$')
1052 {
1053 tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (1);
1054 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
1055 if (!isdigit (text[1]))
1056 complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
1057 return;
1058 }
1059
1060 /* Suggest the "-force" flag if no arguments are given. If
1061 arguments were passed, they either already include the flag,
1062 or we are beyond the point of suggesting it because it's
1063 positionally the first argument. */
1064 if (has_no_arguments)
1065 gdb::option::complete_on_all_options (tracker, group);
1066
1067 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
1068 len = strlen (text);
1069
1070 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
1071 {
1072 char number[50];
1073
1074 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
1075
1076 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
1077 tracker.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (number));
1078 }
1079
1080 return;
1081 }
1082
1083 /* We're completing the expression part. Skip the breakpoint num. */
1084 const char *exp_start = skip_spaces (space);
1085 tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (exp_start - text);
1086 text = exp_start;
1087 const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text);
1088 expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
1089 }
1090
1091 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
1092
1093 static void
1094 condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1095 {
1096 const char *p;
1097 int bnum;
1098
1099 if (arg == 0)
1100 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
1101
1102 p = arg;
1103
1104 /* Check if the "-force" flag was passed. */
1105 condition_command_opts cc_opts;
1106 const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts);
1107 gdb::option::process_options
1108 (&p, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group);
1109
1110 bnum = get_number (&p);
1111 if (bnum == 0)
1112 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
1113
1114 set_breakpoint_condition (bnum, p, from_tty, cc_opts.force_condition);
1115 }
1116
1117 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1118 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1119 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1120
1121 static void
1122 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1123 {
1124 struct command_line *c;
1125
1126 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1127 {
1128 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1129 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1130 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1131
1132 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ());
1133 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ());
1134
1135 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1136 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1137 command directly. */
1138 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1139 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1140
1141 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1142 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1143 }
1144 }
1145
1146 struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
1147 {
1148 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
1149 };
1150
1151 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1152
1153 static bool
1154 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
1155 {
1156 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1157 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1158 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1159 }
1160
1161 static bool
1162 is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
1163 {
1164 return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
1165 }
1166
1167 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1168
1169 bool
1170 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1171 {
1172 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1173 }
1174
1175 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1176 TYPE. */
1177
1178 static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
1179 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
1180 {
1181 breakpoint *b;
1182
1183 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
1184 b = new tracepoint ();
1185 else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
1186 b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1187 else
1188 b = new breakpoint ();
1189
1190 return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
1191 }
1192
1193 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1194 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1195 found. */
1196
1197 static void
1198 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1199 struct command_line *commands)
1200 {
1201 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1202 {
1203 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1204 struct command_line *c;
1205 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1206
1207 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1208 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1209 ones might not. */
1210 t->step_count = 0;
1211
1212 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1213 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1214 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1215 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1216 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1217 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1218 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1219 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1220 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1221 tracepoint's context. */
1222 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1223 {
1224 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1225 {
1226 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1227 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1228 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1229 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1230 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1231 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1232
1233 if (while_stepping)
1234 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1235 "can be used only once"));
1236 else
1237 while_stepping = c;
1238 }
1239
1240 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1241 }
1242 if (while_stepping)
1243 {
1244 struct command_line *c2;
1245
1246 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr);
1247 c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get ();
1248 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1249 {
1250 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1251 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1252 }
1253 }
1254 }
1255 else
1256 {
1257 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1258 }
1259 }
1260
1261 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1262 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1263
1264 std::vector<breakpoint *>
1265 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1266 {
1267 std::vector<breakpoint *> found;
1268
1269 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
1270 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1271 {
1272 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
1273 if (loc->address == addr)
1274 found.push_back (b);
1275 }
1276
1277 return found;
1278 }
1279
1280 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1281 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1282
1283 void
1284 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1285 counted_command_line &&commands)
1286 {
1287 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
1288
1289 b->commands = std::move (commands);
1290 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1291 }
1292
1293 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1294 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1295 commands. */
1296
1297 void
1298 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1299 {
1300 int old_silent = b->silent;
1301
1302 b->silent = silent;
1303 if (old_silent != silent)
1304 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1305 }
1306
1307 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1308 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1309
1310 void
1311 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1312 {
1313 int old_thread = b->thread;
1314
1315 b->thread = thread;
1316 if (old_thread != thread)
1317 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1318 }
1319
1320 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1321 breakpoint work for any task. */
1322
1323 void
1324 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1325 {
1326 int old_task = b->task;
1327
1328 b->task = task;
1329 if (old_task != task)
1330 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1331 }
1332
1333 static void
1334 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1335 struct command_line *control)
1336 {
1337 counted_command_line cmd;
1338 /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be
1339 NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty
1340 list of command by just typing "end". */
1341 bool cmd_read = false;
1342
1343 std::string new_arg;
1344
1345 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1346 {
1347 /* Argument not explicitly given. Synthesize it. */
1348 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1349 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1350 breakpoint_count);
1351 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1352 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1353 }
1354 else
1355 {
1356 /* Create a copy of ARG. This is needed because the "commands"
1357 command may be coming from a script. In that case, the read
1358 line buffer is going to be overwritten in the lambda of
1359 'map_breakpoint_numbers' below when reading the next line
1360 before we are are done parsing the breakpoint numbers. */
1361 new_arg = arg;
1362 }
1363 arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1364
1365 map_breakpoint_numbers
1366 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
1367 {
1368 if (!cmd_read)
1369 {
1370 gdb_assert (cmd == NULL);
1371 if (control != NULL)
1372 cmd = control->body_list_0;
1373 else
1374 {
1375 std::string str
1376 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1377 "%s, one per line."),
1378 arg);
1379
1380 auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line)
1381 {
1382 validate_actionline (line, b);
1383 };
1384 gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator;
1385 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1386 validator = do_validate;
1387
1388 cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator);
1389 }
1390 cmd_read = true;
1391 }
1392
1393 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1394 do anything. */
1395 if (b->commands != cmd)
1396 {
1397 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
1398 b->commands = cmd;
1399 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1400 }
1401 });
1402 }
1403
1404 static void
1405 commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1406 {
1407 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1408 }
1409
1410 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1411 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1412
1413 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1414 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1415 enum command_control_type
1416 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1417 {
1418 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1419 return simple_control;
1420 }
1421
1422 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1423
1424 static int
1425 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1426 {
1427 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1428 return 0;
1429 if (!bl->inserted)
1430 return 0;
1431 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1432 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1433 return 0;
1434 return 1;
1435 }
1436
1437 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1438 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1439 contents.
1440
1441 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1442 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1443 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1444
1445 static void
1446 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1447 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1448 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1449 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1450 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1451 {
1452 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1453 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1454 int bp_size = 0;
1455 int bptoffset = 0;
1456
1457 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1458 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1459 {
1460 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1461 return;
1462 }
1463
1464 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1465 we need to copy. */
1466 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1467 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1468
1469 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1470 {
1471 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1472 reading. */
1473 return;
1474 }
1475
1476 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1477 {
1478 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1479 reading. */
1480 return;
1481 }
1482
1483 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1484 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1485 {
1486 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1487 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1488 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1489 bp_addr = memaddr;
1490 }
1491
1492 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1493 {
1494 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1495 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1496 }
1497
1498 if (readbuf != NULL)
1499 {
1500 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1501 shadow_contents buffer. */
1502 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1503 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1504 + target_info->shadow_len));
1505
1506 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1507 shadow. */
1508 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1509 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1510 }
1511 else
1512 {
1513 const unsigned char *bp;
1514 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1515 int placed_size;
1516
1517 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1518 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1519 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1520
1521 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1522 address. */
1523 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1524
1525 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1526 breakpoint's INSN. */
1527 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1528 }
1529 }
1530
1531 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1532 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1533
1534 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1535 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1536 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1537
1538 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1539 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1540 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1541 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1542 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1543 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1544 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1545 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1546 and:
1547 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1548
1549 void
1550 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1551 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1552 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1553 {
1554 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1555 search. */
1556 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1557
1558 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1559 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1560 report higher one. */
1561
1562 bc_l = 0;
1563 bc_r = bp_locations.size ();
1564 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1565 {
1566 struct bp_location *bl;
1567
1568 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1569 bl = bp_locations[bc];
1570
1571 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1572 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1573 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1574 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1575
1576 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1577 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1578 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1579
1580 if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1581 >= bl->address)
1582 && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1583 <= memaddr))
1584 bc_l = bc;
1585 else
1586 bc_r = bc;
1587 }
1588
1589 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1590 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1591 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1592 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1593 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1594 B:
1595
1596 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1597
1598 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1599 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1600 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1601 and L2. */
1602 while (bc_l > 0
1603 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
1604 bc_l--;
1605
1606 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1607
1608 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations.size (); bc++)
1609 {
1610 struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
1611
1612 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1613 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1614 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1615 bl->owner->number);
1616
1617 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1618 content. */
1619
1620 if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1621 && (memaddr + len
1622 <= (bl->address
1623 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)))
1624 break;
1625
1626 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1627 continue;
1628
1629 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1630 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1631 }
1632 }
1633
1634 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1635
1636 bool
1637 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1638 {
1639 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1640 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1641 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1642 }
1643
1644 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1645
1646 static bool
1647 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1648 {
1649 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1650 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1651 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1652 }
1653
1654 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1655
1656 bool
1657 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1658 {
1659 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1660 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1661 }
1662
1663 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1664 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1665 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1666 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1667 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1668 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1669 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1670 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1671
1672 static int
1673 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1674 {
1675 return (b->pspace == current_program_space
1676 && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid
1677 || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread
1678 && !inferior_thread ()->executing)));
1679 }
1680
1681 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1682 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1683
1684 static void
1685 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1686 {
1687 if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
1688 {
1689 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1690 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
1691 w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1692 w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
1693 w->related_breakpoint = w;
1694 }
1695 w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1696 }
1697
1698 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1699 watchpoint W. */
1700
1701 static struct value *
1702 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1703 {
1704 struct value *bit_val;
1705
1706 if (val == NULL)
1707 return NULL;
1708
1709 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1710
1711 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1712 w->val_bitpos,
1713 w->val_bitsize,
1714 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1715 value_offset (val),
1716 val);
1717
1718 return bit_val;
1719 }
1720
1721 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1722 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1723 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1724 to be able to report stops. */
1725
1726 static void
1727 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1728 struct program_space *pspace)
1729 {
1730 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1731
1732 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1733 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1734 b->loc->address = -1;
1735 b->loc->length = -1;
1736 }
1737
1738 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1739 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1740
1741 static bool
1742 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1743 {
1744 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1745 && b->loc != NULL
1746 && b->loc->next == NULL
1747 && b->loc->address == -1
1748 && b->loc->length == -1);
1749 }
1750
1751 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1752 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1753 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1754 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1755 in b->loc->cond.
1756 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1757
1758 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1759 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1760 it.
1761
1762 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1763 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1764 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1765 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1766 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1767 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1768 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1769 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1770
1771 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1772 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1773 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1774 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1775 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1776 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1777 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1778 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1779 not changed.
1780
1781 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1782 hardware watchpoints:
1783
1784 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1785 called several times when GDB stops.
1786
1787 [linux]
1788 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1789 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1790 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1791 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1792 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1793 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1794 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1795 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1796 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1797 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1798 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1799
1800 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1801 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1802
1803 static void
1804 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1805 {
1806 int within_current_scope;
1807 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1808 int frame_saved;
1809
1810 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1811 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1812 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1813 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1814 return;
1815
1816 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1817 return;
1818
1819 frame_saved = 0;
1820
1821 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1822 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1823 within_current_scope = 1;
1824 else
1825 {
1826 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1827 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1828 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1829
1830 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1831 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1832 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1833 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1834 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1835 return;
1836
1837 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1838 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1839 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1840 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1841 selected frame. */
1842 frame_saved = 1;
1843 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1844
1845 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1846 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1847 if (within_current_scope)
1848 select_frame (fi);
1849 }
1850
1851 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1852 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1853 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1854 b->loc = NULL;
1855
1856 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1857 {
1858 const char *s;
1859
1860 b->exp.reset ();
1861 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1862 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1863 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1864 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1865 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1866 be completely different objects. */
1867 b->val = NULL;
1868 b->val_valid = false;
1869
1870 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1871 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1872 locations (re)created below. */
1873 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1874 {
1875 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1876
1877 s = b->cond_string;
1878 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1879 }
1880 }
1881
1882 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1883 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1884 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1885 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1886 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1887 if (!target_has_execution ())
1888 {
1889 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1890 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1891 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1892 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1893 {
1894 if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1895 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1896 else
1897 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1898 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1899 }
1900 }
1901 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1902 {
1903 std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain;
1904 struct value *v, *result;
1905 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1906
1907 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &v, &result,
1908 &val_chain, false);
1909
1910 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1911 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1912 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1913 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1914 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1915 watchpoints. */
1916 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
1917 {
1918 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1919 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1920 b->val = release_value (v);
1921 b->val_valid = true;
1922 }
1923
1924 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1925
1926 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1927 gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ());
1928 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain)
1929 {
1930 v = iter.get ();
1931
1932 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1933 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1934 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1935 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1936 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1937 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1938 && (v == val_chain[0] || ! value_lazy (v)))
1939 {
1940 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1941
1942 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1943 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1944 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1945 if (v == result
1946 || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1947 && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1948 {
1949 CORE_ADDR addr;
1950 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1951 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1952 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1953
1954 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1955 {
1956 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1957 sub-expression. */
1958 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1959 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1960 }
1961 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1962 {
1963 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1964 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1965 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1966 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1967 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1968 }
1969
1970 addr = value_address (v);
1971 if (bitsize != 0)
1972 {
1973 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1974 addr += bitpos / 8;
1975 }
1976
1977 type = hw_write;
1978 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1979 type = hw_read;
1980 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1981 type = hw_access;
1982
1983 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1984 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1985 ;
1986 *tmp = loc;
1987 loc->gdbarch = value_type (v)->arch ();
1988
1989 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1990 loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr);
1991
1992 if (bitsize != 0)
1993 {
1994 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1995 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
1996 }
1997 else
1998 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1999
2000 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
2001 }
2002 }
2003 }
2004
2005 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
2006 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
2007 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
2008 is started. */
2009 if (reparse)
2010 {
2011 int reg_cnt;
2012 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
2013
2014 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
2015
2016 if (reg_cnt)
2017 {
2018 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
2019 enum bptype type;
2020
2021 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
2022 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
2023 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
2024
2025 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
2026 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
2027 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
2028 this watchpoint in as well. */
2029
2030 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
2031 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
2032 hardware watchpoint type. */
2033 type = b->type;
2034 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
2035 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
2036
2037 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
2038 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
2039 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
2040 through watch_command), so always account for it
2041 manually. */
2042
2043 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
2044 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
2045
2046 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
2047 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
2048
2049 target_resources_ok
2050 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
2051 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
2052 {
2053 int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
2054
2055 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
2056 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
2057 "hardware watchpoint."));
2058 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
2059 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
2060 "resources for this watchpoint."));
2061
2062 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
2063 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
2064 }
2065 else
2066 {
2067 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
2068 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
2069 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
2070 nop. */
2071 b->type = type;
2072 }
2073 }
2074 else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
2075 {
2076 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
2077 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
2078 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
2079 else
2080 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
2081 "read/access watchpoint."));
2082 }
2083 else
2084 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
2085
2086 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
2087 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
2088 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
2089 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
2090 }
2091
2092 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
2093 above left it without any location set up. But,
2094 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
2095 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
2096 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
2097 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
2098 }
2099 else if (!within_current_scope)
2100 {
2101 printf_filtered (_("\
2102 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
2103 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
2104 b->number);
2105 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
2106 }
2107
2108 /* Restore the selected frame. */
2109 if (frame_saved)
2110 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
2111 }
2112
2113
2114 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
2115 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
2116 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
2117 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
2118 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
2119 static int
2120 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2121 {
2122 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2123 return 0;
2124
2125 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2126 return 0;
2127
2128 if (!bl->enabled || bl->disabled_by_cond
2129 || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2130 return 0;
2131
2132 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2133 return 0;
2134
2135 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2136 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2137 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2138 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2139 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2140 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2141 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2142 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2143 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2144 return 0;
2145
2146 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2147 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2148 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2149 a breakpoint. */
2150 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2151 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2152 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2153 bl->address)
2154 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2155 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2156 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2157 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2158 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2159 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2160 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2161 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2162 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2163 {
2164 infrun_debug_printf ("skipping breakpoint: stepping past insn at: %s",
2165 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2166 return 0;
2167 }
2168
2169 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2170 instruction that triggered one. */
2171 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2172 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2173 {
2174 infrun_debug_printf ("stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2175 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d",
2176 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address), bl->length);
2177 return 0;
2178 }
2179
2180 return 1;
2181 }
2182
2183 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2184 that the location is not duplicated. */
2185
2186 static int
2187 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2188 {
2189 int result;
2190 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2191
2192 bl->duplicate = 0;
2193 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2194 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2195 return result;
2196 }
2197
2198 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2199 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2200 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2201 any error during parsing. */
2202
2203 static agent_expr_up
2204 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2205 {
2206 if (cond == NULL)
2207 return NULL;
2208
2209 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2210
2211 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2212 that may show up. */
2213 try
2214 {
2215 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2216 }
2217
2218 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
2219 {
2220 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2221 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2222 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2223 }
2224
2225 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2226 return aexpr;
2227 }
2228
2229 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2230 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2231 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2232 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2233 one of them is true. */
2234
2235 static void
2236 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2237 {
2238 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2239 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2240
2241 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2242 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2243
2244 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2245 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2246 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2247 side. */
2248 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2249 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2250 return;
2251
2252 auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address);
2253
2254 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2255 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent
2256 expression bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to
2257 send conditions to the target since this location will always
2258 trigger and generate a response back to GDB. Note we consider
2259 all locations at the same address irrespective of type, i.e.,
2260 even if the locations aren't considered duplicates (e.g.,
2261 software breakpoint and hardware breakpoint at the same
2262 address). */
2263 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2264 {
2265 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2266 {
2267 if (modified)
2268 {
2269 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2270 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2271 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2272 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2273 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2274 loc->cond.get ());
2275 }
2276
2277 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2278 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2279 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2280 {
2281 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2282 break;
2283 }
2284 }
2285 }
2286
2287 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2288 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2289 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2290
2291 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2292 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2293 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2294 {
2295 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2296 {
2297 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2298 {
2299 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2300 located. */
2301 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2302 return;
2303
2304 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2305 }
2306 }
2307 }
2308
2309 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a
2310 condition list for this location's address. If we have software
2311 and hardware locations at the same address, they aren't
2312 considered duplicates, but we still marge all the conditions
2313 anyway, as it's simpler, and doesn't really make a practical
2314 difference. */
2315 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2316 if (loc->cond
2317 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2318 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2319 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2320 && loc->enabled
2321 && !loc->disabled_by_cond)
2322 {
2323 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2324 to send the conditions to the target. */
2325 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2326 }
2327
2328 return;
2329 }
2330
2331 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2332 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2333 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2334
2335 static agent_expr_up
2336 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2337 {
2338 const char *cmdrest;
2339 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2340 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2341
2342 if (cmd == NULL)
2343 return NULL;
2344
2345 cmdrest = cmd;
2346
2347 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2348 ++cmdrest;
2349 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2350
2351 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2352 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2353
2354 format_start = cmdrest;
2355
2356 format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest);
2357
2358 format_end = cmdrest;
2359
2360 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2361 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2362
2363 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2364
2365 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2366 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2367
2368 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2369 cmdrest++;
2370 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2371
2372 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2373
2374 std::vector<struct expression *> argvec;
2375 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2376 {
2377 const char *cmd1;
2378
2379 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2380 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2381 argvec.push_back (expr.release ());
2382 cmdrest = cmd1;
2383 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2384 ++cmdrest;
2385 }
2386
2387 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2388
2389 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2390 that may show up. */
2391 try
2392 {
2393 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2394 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2395 argvec.size (), argvec.data ());
2396 }
2397 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
2398 {
2399 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2400 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2401 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2402 }
2403
2404 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2405 return aexpr;
2406 }
2407
2408 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2409 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2410 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2411
2412 static void
2413 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2414 {
2415 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2416 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2417
2418 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2419 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2420
2421 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2422 return;
2423
2424 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2425 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2426 return;
2427
2428 auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address);
2429
2430 /* For now, if we have any location at the same address that isn't a
2431 dprintf, don't install the target-side commands, as that would
2432 make the breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2433 control. */
2434 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2435 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2436 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2437 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2438 return;
2439
2440 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2441 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2442 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2443 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2444 response back to GDB. */
2445 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2446 {
2447 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2448 {
2449 if (modified)
2450 {
2451 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2452 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2453 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2454 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2455 loc->cmd_bytecode
2456 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2457 loc->owner->extra_string);
2458 }
2459
2460 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2461 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2462 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2463 {
2464 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2465 break;
2466 }
2467 }
2468 }
2469
2470 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2471 and so clean up. */
2472 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2473 {
2474 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2475 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2476 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2477 {
2478 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2479 located. */
2480 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2481 return;
2482
2483 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2484 }
2485 }
2486
2487 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command
2488 list for all duplicate locations at this location's address.
2489 Note that here we must care for whether the breakpoint location
2490 types are considered duplicates, otherwise, say, if we have a
2491 software and hardware location at the same address, the target
2492 could end up running the commands twice. For the moment, we only
2493 support targets-side commands with dprintf, but it doesn't hurt
2494 to be pedantically correct in case that changes. */
2495 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2496 if (breakpoint_locations_match (bl, loc)
2497 && loc->owner->extra_string
2498 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2499 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2500 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2501 && loc->enabled
2502 && !loc->disabled_by_cond)
2503 {
2504 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2505 to send the commands to the target. */
2506 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2507 }
2508
2509 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2510 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2511 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2512 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2513 }
2514
2515 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2516 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2517 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2518 registers state. */
2519
2520 static int
2521 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2522 {
2523 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2524 {
2525 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2526 struct regcache *regcache;
2527
2528 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr);
2529
2530 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2531 regcache, addr);
2532 }
2533 else
2534 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2535 }
2536
2537 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2538 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2539 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2540 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2541 -1 for failure.
2542
2543 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2544 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2545 static int
2546 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2547 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2548 int *disabled_breaks,
2549 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2550 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2551 {
2552 gdb_exception bp_excpt;
2553
2554 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2555 return 0;
2556
2557 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2558 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2559 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2560 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2561 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2562 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2563 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2564 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2565 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2566 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2567 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2568 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2569
2570 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2571 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2572 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2573 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2574
2575 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2576 {
2577 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2578 build_target_command_list (bl);
2579 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2580 bl->needs_update = 0;
2581 }
2582
2583 /* If "set breakpoint auto-hw" is "on" and a software breakpoint was
2584 set at a read-only address, then a breakpoint location will have
2585 been changed to hardware breakpoint before we get here. If it is
2586 "off" however, error out before actually trying to insert the
2587 breakpoint, with a nicer error message. */
2588 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2589 && !automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2590 {
2591 mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address);
2592
2593 if (mr != nullptr && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2594 {
2595 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2596 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2597 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2598 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2599 bl->owner->number,
2600 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2601 return 1;
2602 }
2603 }
2604
2605 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2606 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2607 {
2608 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2609 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2610 || bl->section == NULL
2611 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2612 {
2613 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2614 try
2615 {
2616 int val;
2617
2618 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2619 if (val)
2620 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2621 }
2622 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2623 {
2624 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2625 }
2626 }
2627 else
2628 {
2629 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2630 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2631 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2632 {
2633 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2634 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2635 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2636 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2637 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2638 bl->owner->number);
2639 else
2640 {
2641 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2642 bl->section);
2643 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2644 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2645 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2646
2647 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2648 try
2649 {
2650 int val;
2651
2652 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2653 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2654 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2655 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2656 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2657 if (val)
2658 bp_excpt
2659 = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2660 }
2661 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2662 {
2663 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2664 }
2665
2666 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2667 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2668 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2669 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2670 bl->owner->number);
2671 }
2672 }
2673 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2674 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2675 {
2676 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2677 try
2678 {
2679 int val;
2680
2681 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2682 if (val)
2683 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2684 }
2685 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2686 {
2687 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2688 }
2689 }
2690 else
2691 {
2692 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2693 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2694 return 0;
2695 }
2696 }
2697
2698 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2699 {
2700 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2701
2702 /* If the target has closed then it will have deleted any
2703 breakpoints inserted within the target inferior, as a result
2704 any further attempts to interact with the breakpoint objects
2705 is not possible. Just rethrow the error. */
2706 if (bp_excpt.error == TARGET_CLOSE_ERROR)
2707 throw bp_excpt;
2708 gdb_assert (bl->owner != nullptr);
2709
2710 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2711 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2712 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2713 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2714 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2715 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2716 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2717 errors as memory errors. */
2718 if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR
2719 && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR
2720 || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR)
2721 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2722 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2723 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2724 bl->address)))
2725 {
2726 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2727 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2728 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bl->owner);
2729 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2730 {
2731 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2732 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2733 bl->owner->number);
2734 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2735 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2736 "library breakpoints:\n");
2737 }
2738 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2739 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2740 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2741 return 0;
2742 }
2743 else
2744 {
2745 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2746 {
2747 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2748 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL;
2749 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2750 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2751 bl->owner->number,
2752 bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n");
2753 if (bp_excpt.message != NULL)
2754 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n",
2755 bp_excpt.what ());
2756 }
2757 else
2758 {
2759 if (bp_excpt.message == NULL)
2760 {
2761 std::string message
2762 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2763 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2764
2765 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2766 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2767 "%s\n",
2768 bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
2769 }
2770 else
2771 {
2772 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2773 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2774 bl->owner->number,
2775 bp_excpt.what ());
2776 }
2777 }
2778 return 1;
2779
2780 }
2781 }
2782 else
2783 bl->inserted = 1;
2784
2785 return 0;
2786 }
2787
2788 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2789 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2790 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2791 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2792 {
2793 int val;
2794
2795 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2796 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2797
2798 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2799
2800 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2801 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2802 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2803 {
2804 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2805 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2806 of this one. */
2807 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
2808 if (loc != bl
2809 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2810 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2811 {
2812 bl->duplicate = 1;
2813 bl->inserted = 1;
2814 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2815 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2816 val = 0;
2817 break;
2818 }
2819
2820 if (val == 1)
2821 {
2822 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2823 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2824
2825 if (val)
2826 /* Back to the original value. */
2827 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2828 }
2829 }
2830
2831 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2832 }
2833
2834 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2835 {
2836 int val;
2837
2838 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2839 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2840
2841 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2842 if (val)
2843 {
2844 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2845
2846 if (val == 1)
2847 warning (_("\
2848 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2849 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2850 else
2851 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2852 }
2853
2854 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2855
2856 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2857 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2858 so just return success. */
2859 return 0;
2860 }
2861
2862 return 0;
2863 }
2864
2865 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2866 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2867 PSPACE anymore. */
2868
2869 void
2870 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2871 {
2872 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2873 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
2874 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2875 delete_breakpoint (b);
2876
2877 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2878 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2879 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
2880 {
2881 struct bp_location *tmp;
2882
2883 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2884 {
2885 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2886 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2887 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2888 else
2889 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2890 if (tmp->next == loc)
2891 {
2892 tmp->next = loc->next;
2893 break;
2894 }
2895 }
2896 }
2897
2898 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2899 removed locations above. */
2900 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2901 }
2902
2903 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2904 Throws exception on any error.
2905 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2906 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2907 void
2908 insert_breakpoints (void)
2909 {
2910 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
2911 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2912 {
2913 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2914
2915 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2916 }
2917
2918 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2919 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2920 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. Also,
2921 update_global_location_list tries to "upgrade" software
2922 breakpoints to hardware breakpoints to handle "set breakpoint
2923 auto-hw", so we need to call it even if we don't have new
2924 locations. */
2925 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2926 }
2927
2928 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2929 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2930 always-inserted mode. */
2931
2932 static void
2933 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2934 {
2935 int error_flag = 0;
2936 int val = 0;
2937 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2938 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2939 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2940
2941 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2942
2943 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2944 there was an error. */
2945 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2946
2947 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2948
2949 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
2950 {
2951 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2952 breakpoints. */
2953 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2954 continue;
2955
2956 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2957 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2958 deletion of breakpoints. */
2959 if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update)
2960 continue;
2961
2962 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2963
2964 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2965 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2966 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2967 insert breakpoints. */
2968 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2969 && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ()))
2970 continue;
2971
2972 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2973 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2974 if (val)
2975 error_flag = val;
2976 }
2977
2978 if (error_flag)
2979 {
2980 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2981 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2982 }
2983 }
2984
2985 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2986
2987 static void
2988 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2989 {
2990 int error_flag = 0;
2991 int val = 0;
2992 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2993 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2994 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2995
2996 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2997
2998 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2999 there was an error. */
3000 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
3001
3002 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3003
3004 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3005 {
3006 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
3007 continue;
3008
3009 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
3010 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
3011 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3012 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
3013 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
3014 continue;
3015
3016 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3017
3018 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3019 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3020 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3021 insert breakpoints. */
3022 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3023 && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ()))
3024 continue;
3025
3026 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3027 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
3028 if (val)
3029 error_flag = val;
3030 }
3031
3032 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
3033 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
3034 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
3035 {
3036 int some_failed = 0;
3037
3038 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3039 continue;
3040
3041 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
3042 continue;
3043
3044 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
3045 continue;
3046
3047 for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ())
3048 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3049 {
3050 some_failed = 1;
3051 break;
3052 }
3053
3054 if (some_failed)
3055 {
3056 for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ())
3057 if (loc->inserted)
3058 remove_breakpoint (loc);
3059
3060 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3061 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
3062 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3063 bpt->number);
3064 error_flag = -1;
3065 }
3066 }
3067
3068 if (error_flag)
3069 {
3070 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3071 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3072 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3073 {
3074 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3075 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3076 }
3077 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
3078 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3079 }
3080 }
3081
3082 /* Used when the program stops.
3083 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3084 removing a breakpoint location. */
3085
3086 int
3087 remove_breakpoints (void)
3088 {
3089 int val = 0;
3090
3091 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3092 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3093 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3094
3095 return val;
3096 }
3097
3098 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3099 that thread. */
3100
3101 static void
3102 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3103 {
3104 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
3105 {
3106 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3107 {
3108 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3109
3110 printf_filtered (_("\
3111 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3112 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3113
3114 /* Hide it from the user. */
3115 b->number = 0;
3116 }
3117 }
3118 }
3119
3120 /* See breakpoint.h. */
3121
3122 void
3123 remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf)
3124 {
3125 int val;
3126
3127 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3128 {
3129 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3130 continue;
3131
3132 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3133 {
3134 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3135 if (val != 0)
3136 return;
3137 }
3138 }
3139 }
3140
3141 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3142
3143 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3144 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3145 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3146 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3147 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3148 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3149 static void
3150 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3151 {
3152 if (internal)
3153 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3154 else
3155 {
3156 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3157 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3158 }
3159 }
3160
3161 static struct breakpoint *
3162 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3163 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3164 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3165 {
3166 symtab_and_line sal;
3167 sal.pc = address;
3168 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3169 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3170
3171 breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3172 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3173 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3174
3175 return b;
3176 }
3177
3178 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3179 {
3180 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3181 };
3182 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3183
3184 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3185 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3186 {
3187 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3188 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym {};
3189
3190 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3191 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES] {};
3192
3193 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3194 int longjmp_searched = 0;
3195
3196 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3197 references. */
3198 std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
3199
3200 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3201 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym {};
3202
3203 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3204 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym {};
3205
3206 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3207 int exception_searched = 0;
3208
3209 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3210 references. */
3211 std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
3212 };
3213
3214 static const struct objfile_key<breakpoint_objfile_data>
3215 breakpoint_objfile_key;
3216
3217 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3218 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3219
3220 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3221
3222 static int
3223 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3224 {
3225 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3226 }
3227
3228 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3229 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3230
3231 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3232 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3233 {
3234 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3235
3236 bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.get (objfile);
3237 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3238 bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.emplace (objfile);
3239 return bp_objfile_data;
3240 }
3241
3242 static void
3243 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3244 {
3245 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3246
3247 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3248 {
3249 struct breakpoint *b;
3250 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3251 CORE_ADDR addr;
3252 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3253
3254 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3255
3256 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3257 continue;
3258
3259 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3260 {
3261 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3262
3263 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3264 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3265 {
3266 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3267 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3268 continue;
3269 }
3270 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3271 }
3272
3273 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3274 b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), addr,
3275 bp_overlay_event,
3276 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3277 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3278 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3279 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3280
3281 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3282 {
3283 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3284 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3285 }
3286 else
3287 {
3288 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3289 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3290 }
3291 }
3292 }
3293
3294 /* Install a master longjmp breakpoint for OBJFILE using a probe. Return
3295 true if a breakpoint was installed. */
3296
3297 static bool
3298 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile)
3299 {
3300 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3301 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3302 = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3303
3304 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3305 {
3306 std::vector<probe *> ret
3307 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3308
3309 if (!ret.empty ())
3310 {
3311 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3312 probe *p = ret[0];
3313
3314 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3315 {
3316 /* We cannot use the probe interface here,
3317 because it does not know how to evaluate
3318 arguments. */
3319 ret.clear ();
3320 }
3321 }
3322 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3323 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3324 }
3325
3326 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
3327 return false;
3328
3329 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
3330 {
3331 struct breakpoint *b;
3332
3333 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3334 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3335 bp_longjmp_master,
3336 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3337 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3338 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3339 }
3340
3341 return true;
3342 }
3343
3344 /* Install master longjmp breakpoints for OBJFILE using longjmp_names.
3345 Return true if at least one breakpoint was installed. */
3346
3347 static bool
3348 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (objfile *objfile)
3349 {
3350 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3351 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3352 return false;
3353
3354 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3355 = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3356 unsigned int installed_bp = 0;
3357
3358 for (int i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3359 {
3360 struct breakpoint *b;
3361 const char *func_name;
3362 CORE_ADDR addr;
3363 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3364
3365 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3366 continue;
3367
3368 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3369 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3370 {
3371 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3372
3373 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3374 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3375 {
3376 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3377 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3378 continue;
3379 }
3380 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3381 }
3382
3383 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3384 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3385 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3386 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3387 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3388 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3389 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3390 installed_bp++;
3391 }
3392
3393 return installed_bp > 0;
3394 }
3395
3396 /* Create a master longjmp breakpoint. */
3397
3398 static void
3399 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3400 {
3401 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3402
3403 for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces)
3404 {
3405 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3406
3407 for (objfile *obj : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3408 {
3409 /* Skip separate debug object, it's handled in the loop below. */
3410 if (obj->separate_debug_objfile_backlink != nullptr)
3411 continue;
3412
3413 /* Try a probe kind breakpoint on main objfile. */
3414 if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (obj))
3415 continue;
3416
3417 /* Try longjmp_names kind breakpoints on main and separate_debug
3418 objfiles. */
3419 for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj->separate_debug_objfiles ())
3420 if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (debug_objfile))
3421 break;
3422 }
3423 }
3424 }
3425
3426 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3427 static void
3428 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3429 {
3430 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3431
3432 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3433
3434 for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces)
3435 {
3436 CORE_ADDR addr;
3437
3438 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3439
3440 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3441 {
3442 struct breakpoint *b;
3443 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3444 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3445
3446 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3447
3448 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3449 continue;
3450
3451 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3452 {
3453 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3454
3455 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3456 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3457 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3458 {
3459 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3460 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3461 continue;
3462 }
3463 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3464 }
3465
3466 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3467 b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), addr,
3468 bp_std_terminate_master,
3469 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3470 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3471 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3472 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3473 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3474 }
3475 }
3476 }
3477
3478 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using a
3479 probe. Return true if a breakpoint was installed. */
3480
3481 static bool
3482 create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile)
3483 {
3484 struct breakpoint *b;
3485 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3486 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3487
3488 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3489
3490 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3491 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3492 {
3493 std::vector<probe *> ret
3494 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3495
3496 if (!ret.empty ())
3497 {
3498 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3499 probe *p = ret[0];
3500
3501 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3502 {
3503 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3504 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3505 ret.clear ();
3506 }
3507 }
3508 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3509 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3510 }
3511
3512 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
3513 return false;
3514
3515 gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3516
3517 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
3518 {
3519 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3520 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3521 bp_exception_master,
3522 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3523 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3524 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3525 }
3526
3527 return true;
3528 }
3529
3530 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using
3531 _Unwind_DebugHook. Return true if a breakpoint was installed. */
3532
3533 static bool
3534 create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (objfile *objfile)
3535 {
3536 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3537 struct breakpoint *b;
3538 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3539 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3540 CORE_ADDR addr;
3541 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3542
3543 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3544
3545 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3546 return false;
3547
3548 gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3549
3550 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3551 {
3552 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3553
3554 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3555 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3556 {
3557 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3558 return false;
3559 }
3560
3561 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3562 }
3563
3564 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3565 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr
3566 (gdbarch, addr, current_inferior ()->top_target ());
3567 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3568 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3569 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3570 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3571 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3572 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3573
3574 return true;
3575 }
3576
3577 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3578
3579 static void
3580 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3581 {
3582 for (objfile *obj : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3583 {
3584 /* Skip separate debug object. */
3585 if (obj->separate_debug_objfile_backlink)
3586 continue;
3587
3588 /* Try a probe kind breakpoint. */
3589 if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (obj))
3590 continue;
3591
3592 /* Iterate over main and separate debug objects and try an
3593 _Unwind_DebugHook kind breakpoint. */
3594 for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj->separate_debug_objfiles ())
3595 if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (debug_objfile))
3596 break;
3597 }
3598 }
3599
3600 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3601
3602 static int
3603 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3604 {
3605 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
3606 }
3607
3608 void
3609 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3610 {
3611 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3612 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3613 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3614 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3615 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3616 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3617 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3618 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3619 for (bp_location *bploc : all_bp_locations ())
3620 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3621 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3622
3623 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
3624 {
3625 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3626 continue;
3627
3628 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3629 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3630 {
3631 delete_breakpoint (b);
3632 continue;
3633 }
3634
3635 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3636 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3637 {
3638 delete_breakpoint (b);
3639 continue;
3640 }
3641
3642 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3643 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3644 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3645 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3646 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3647 {
3648 delete_breakpoint (b);
3649 continue;
3650 }
3651
3652 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3653 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3654 {
3655 delete_breakpoint (b);
3656 continue;
3657 }
3658
3659 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3660 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3661 {
3662 delete_breakpoint (b);
3663 continue;
3664 }
3665
3666 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3667 after an exec. */
3668 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3669 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3670 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3671 {
3672 delete_breakpoint (b);
3673 continue;
3674 }
3675
3676 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3677 {
3678 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3679 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3680 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3681 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3682 continue;
3683 }
3684
3685 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3686 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3687 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3688 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3689 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3690 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3691
3692 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3693 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3694 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3695 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3696 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3697 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3698 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3699
3700 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3701 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3702 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3703 let finish_command delete it.
3704
3705 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3706 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3707 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3708 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3709 solib breakpoints.) */
3710
3711 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3712 {
3713 continue;
3714 }
3715
3716 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3717 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3718 a.out. */
3719 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3720 {
3721 delete_breakpoint (b);
3722 continue;
3723 }
3724 }
3725 }
3726
3727 int
3728 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3729 {
3730 int val = 0;
3731 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
3732 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3733
3734 if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ())
3735 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3736
3737 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3738 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3739 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3740 {
3741 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3742 continue;
3743
3744 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3745 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3746 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3747 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3748 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3749 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3750 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3751 continue;
3752
3753 if (bl->inserted)
3754 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3755 }
3756
3757 return val;
3758 }
3759
3760 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3761 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3762 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3763 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3764 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3765
3766 static int
3767 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3768 {
3769 int val;
3770
3771 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3772 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3773
3774 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3775 This should not ever happen. */
3776 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3777
3778 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3779 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3780 {
3781 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3782 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3783 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3784
3785 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3786 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3787 || bl->section == NULL
3788 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3789 {
3790 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3791
3792 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3793 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3794 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3795 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3796 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3797 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3798 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3799 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3800 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3801 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3802 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3803 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3804 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3805 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3806 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3807 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3808 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3809 they should always be removed. */
3810 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3811 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3812 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3813 val = 0;
3814 else
3815 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3816 }
3817 else
3818 {
3819 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3820 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3821 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3822 {
3823 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3824 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3825 */
3826 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3827 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3828 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3829 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3830 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3831 else
3832 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3833 &bl->overlay_target_info,
3834 reason);
3835 }
3836 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3837 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3838 if (bl->inserted)
3839 {
3840 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3841 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3842 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3843 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3844
3845 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3846 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3847 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3848 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3849 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3850 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3851 else
3852 val = 0;
3853 }
3854 else
3855 {
3856 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3857 val = 0;
3858 }
3859 }
3860
3861 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3862 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3863 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3864 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3865 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3866 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3867 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3868 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3869 always-inserted mode. */
3870 if (val
3871 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3872 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3873 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3874 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3875 bl->address))))
3876 val = 0;
3877
3878 if (val)
3879 return val;
3880 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3881 }
3882 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3883 {
3884 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3885 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3886
3887 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3888 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3889
3890 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3891 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
3892 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3893 bl->owner->number);
3894 }
3895 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3896 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3897 && !bl->duplicate)
3898 {
3899 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3900 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3901
3902 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3903 if (val)
3904 return val;
3905
3906 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3907 }
3908
3909 return 0;
3910 }
3911
3912 static int
3913 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
3914 {
3915 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3916 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3917
3918 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3919 This should not ever happen. */
3920 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3921
3922 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3923
3924 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3925
3926 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
3927 }
3928
3929 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3930
3931 void
3932 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3933 {
3934 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3935 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3936 bl->inserted = 0;
3937 }
3938
3939 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3940 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3941
3942 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3943 between runs.
3944
3945 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3946 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3947 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3948
3949
3950
3951 void
3952 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3953 {
3954 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3955
3956 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3957 nothing to do. */
3958 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3959 return;
3960
3961 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3962
3963 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
3964 {
3965 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3966 continue;
3967
3968 switch (b->type)
3969 {
3970 case bp_call_dummy:
3971 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3972
3973 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3974 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3975 rid of it. */
3976
3977 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3978
3979 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3980
3981 case bp_shlib_event:
3982
3983 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3984 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3985 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3986 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3987 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3988
3989 (gdb) file prog-linux
3990 (gdb) run # native linux target
3991 ...
3992 (gdb) kill
3993 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3994 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3995 */
3996
3997 case bp_step_resume:
3998
3999 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
4000
4001 case bp_single_step:
4002
4003 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
4004
4005 delete_breakpoint (b);
4006 break;
4007
4008 case bp_watchpoint:
4009 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4010 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4011 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4012 {
4013 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4014
4015 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
4016 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
4017 delete_breakpoint (b);
4018 else
4019 {
4020 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
4021 valid. New ones will be created in
4022 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
4023 The next update_global_location_list call will
4024 garbage collect them. */
4025 b->loc = NULL;
4026
4027 if (context == inf_starting)
4028 {
4029 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
4030 insert_breakpoints. */
4031 w->val.reset (nullptr);
4032 w->val_valid = false;
4033 }
4034 }
4035 }
4036 break;
4037 default:
4038 break;
4039 }
4040 }
4041
4042 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
4043 for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations)
4044 decref_bp_location (&bl);
4045 moribund_locations.clear ();
4046 }
4047
4048 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
4049 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
4050 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
4051 match, not program space. */
4052
4053 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
4054 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
4055 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
4056 permanent breakpoint.
4057 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
4058 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
4059 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
4060 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
4061 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
4062
4063 enum breakpoint_here
4064 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4065 {
4066 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
4067
4068 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
4069 {
4070 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4071 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4072 continue;
4073
4074 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4075 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4076 || bl->permanent)
4077 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4078 {
4079 if (overlay_debugging
4080 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4081 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4082 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4083 else if (bl->permanent)
4084 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
4085 else
4086 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4087 }
4088 }
4089
4090 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4091 }
4092
4093 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4094
4095 int
4096 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
4097 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4098 {
4099 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
4100 {
4101 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4102 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4103 continue;
4104
4105 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4106 || bl->permanent)
4107 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
4108 addr, len))
4109 {
4110 if (overlay_debugging
4111 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4112 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4113 {
4114 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4115 continue;
4116 }
4117
4118 return 1;
4119 }
4120 }
4121
4122 return 0;
4123 }
4124
4125 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4126
4127 int
4128 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4129 {
4130 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
4131 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4132 return 1;
4133
4134 return 0;
4135 }
4136
4137 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4138 ASPACE. */
4139
4140 static int
4141 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4142 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4143 {
4144 if (bl->inserted
4145 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4146 aspace, pc))
4147 {
4148 if (overlay_debugging
4149 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4150 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4151 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4152 else
4153 return 1;
4154 }
4155 return 0;
4156 }
4157
4158 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4159
4160 int
4161 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4162 {
4163 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc))
4164 {
4165 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4166 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4167 continue;
4168
4169 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4170 return 1;
4171 }
4172 return 0;
4173 }
4174
4175 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4176 inserted at PC. */
4177
4178 int
4179 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4180 CORE_ADDR pc)
4181 {
4182 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc))
4183 {
4184 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4185 continue;
4186
4187 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4188 return 1;
4189 }
4190
4191 return 0;
4192 }
4193
4194 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4195
4196 int
4197 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4198 CORE_ADDR pc)
4199 {
4200 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc))
4201 {
4202 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4203 continue;
4204
4205 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4206 return 1;
4207 }
4208
4209 return 0;
4210 }
4211
4212 int
4213 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
4214 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4215 {
4216 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
4217 {
4218 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4219 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4220 continue;
4221
4222 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4223 continue;
4224
4225 for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ())
4226 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4227 {
4228 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4229
4230 /* Check for intersection. */
4231 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4232 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4233 if (l < h)
4234 return 1;
4235 }
4236 }
4237 return 0;
4238 }
4239
4240 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4241
4242 bool
4243 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
4244 {
4245 return (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
4246 }
4247
4248 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4249 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4250
4251 void
4252 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4253 {
4254 bpstat p;
4255 bpstat q;
4256
4257 if (bsp == 0)
4258 return;
4259 p = *bsp;
4260 while (p != NULL)
4261 {
4262 q = p->next;
4263 delete p;
4264 p = q;
4265 }
4266 *bsp = NULL;
4267 }
4268
4269 bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats &other)
4270 : next (NULL),
4271 bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
4272 breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
4273 commands (other.commands),
4274 print (other.print),
4275 stop (other.stop),
4276 print_it (other.print_it)
4277 {
4278 if (other.old_val != NULL)
4279 old_val = release_value (value_copy (other.old_val.get ()));
4280 }
4281
4282 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4283 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4284
4285 bpstat
4286 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4287 {
4288 bpstat p = NULL;
4289 bpstat tmp;
4290 bpstat retval = NULL;
4291
4292 if (bs == NULL)
4293 return bs;
4294
4295 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4296 {
4297 tmp = new bpstats (*bs);
4298
4299 if (p == NULL)
4300 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4301 retval = tmp;
4302 else
4303 p->next = tmp;
4304 p = tmp;
4305 }
4306 p->next = NULL;
4307 return retval;
4308 }
4309
4310 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4311
4312 bpstat
4313 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4314 {
4315 if (bsp == NULL)
4316 return NULL;
4317
4318 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4319 {
4320 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4321 return bsp;
4322 }
4323 return NULL;
4324 }
4325
4326 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4327
4328 bool
4329 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4330 {
4331 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4332 {
4333 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4334 {
4335 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4336 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4337 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4338 return true;
4339 }
4340 else
4341 {
4342 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4343 sig))
4344 return true;
4345 }
4346 }
4347
4348 return false;
4349 }
4350
4351 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4352 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4353 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4354 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4355
4356 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4357 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4358 we set it.
4359 Return 1 otherwise. */
4360
4361 int
4362 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4363 {
4364 struct breakpoint *b;
4365
4366 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4367 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4368
4369 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4370 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4371 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4372 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4373 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4374 if (b == NULL)
4375 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4376
4377 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4378 return 1;
4379 }
4380
4381 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4382
4383 void
4384 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4385 {
4386 bpstat bs;
4387
4388 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
4389 return;
4390
4391 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4392 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4393 {
4394 bs->commands = NULL;
4395 bs->old_val.reset (nullptr);
4396 }
4397 }
4398
4399 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4400
4401 static void
4402 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4403 {
4404 if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid)
4405 {
4406 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4407
4408 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4409 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4410 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4411 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4412 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4413 return;
4414 }
4415
4416 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4417 }
4418
4419 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4420 or its equivalent. */
4421
4422 static int
4423 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4424 {
4425 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4426 }
4427
4428 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4429 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4430 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4431 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4432
4433 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4434 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4435 bpstat of the current thread. */
4436
4437 static int
4438 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4439 {
4440 bpstat bs;
4441 int again = 0;
4442
4443 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4444 in bs->commands. */
4445 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4446 return 0;
4447
4448 scoped_restore save_executing
4449 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
4450
4451 scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
4452
4453 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4454 bs = *bsp;
4455
4456 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4457 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4458 {
4459 struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
4460
4461 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4462
4463 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4464 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4465 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4466 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4467 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4468 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4469 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4470 the tree when we're done. */
4471 counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
4472 bs->commands = NULL;
4473 if (ccmd != NULL)
4474 cmd = ccmd.get ();
4475 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4476 {
4477 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4478 cmd = cmd->next;
4479 }
4480
4481 while (cmd != NULL)
4482 {
4483 execute_control_command (cmd);
4484
4485 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4486 break;
4487 else
4488 cmd = cmd->next;
4489 }
4490
4491 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4492 {
4493 if (current_ui->async)
4494 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4495 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4496 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4497 ;
4498 else
4499 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4500 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4501 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4502 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4503 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4504 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4505 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4506 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4507 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4508 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4509 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4510 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4511 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4512 again = 1;
4513 break;
4514 }
4515 }
4516 return again;
4517 }
4518
4519 /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's
4520 one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */
4521
4522 static thread_info *
4523 get_bpstat_thread ()
4524 {
4525 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ())
4526 return NULL;
4527
4528 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4529 if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing)
4530 return NULL;
4531 return tp;
4532 }
4533
4534 void
4535 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4536 {
4537 auto cleanup_if_error = make_scope_exit (bpstat_clear_actions);
4538 thread_info *tp;
4539
4540 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4541 while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL)
4542 {
4543 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the
4544 inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next
4545 breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns
4546 false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4547 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat))
4548 break;
4549 }
4550
4551 cleanup_if_error.release ();
4552 }
4553
4554 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4555
4556 static void
4557 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4558 {
4559 if (val == NULL)
4560 fprintf_styled (stream, metadata_style.style (), _("<unreadable>"));
4561 else
4562 {
4563 struct value_print_options opts;
4564 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4565 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4566 }
4567 }
4568
4569 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4570 debugging multiple threads. */
4571
4572 void
4573 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4574 {
4575 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4576 return;
4577
4578 uiout->text ("\n");
4579
4580 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4581 {
4582 const char *name;
4583 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4584
4585 uiout->text ("Thread ");
4586 uiout->field_string ("thread-id", print_thread_id (thr));
4587
4588 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4589 if (name != NULL)
4590 {
4591 uiout->text (" \"");
4592 uiout->field_string ("name", name);
4593 uiout->text ("\"");
4594 }
4595
4596 uiout->text (" hit ");
4597 }
4598 }
4599
4600 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4601 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4602 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4603 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4604 normal_stop(). */
4605
4606 static enum print_stop_action
4607 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4608 {
4609 switch (bs->print_it)
4610 {
4611 case print_it_noop:
4612 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4613 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4614 break;
4615
4616 case print_it_done:
4617 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4618 relevant messages. */
4619 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4620 break;
4621
4622 case print_it_normal:
4623 {
4624 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4625
4626 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4627 which has since been deleted. */
4628 if (b == NULL)
4629 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4630
4631 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4632 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4633 }
4634 break;
4635
4636 default:
4637 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4638 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4639 break;
4640 }
4641 }
4642
4643 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4644
4645 static void
4646 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4647 {
4648 bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty ();
4649 bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty ();
4650
4651 if (!is_catchpoint)
4652 {
4653 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4654 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4655 else
4656 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4657 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4658 }
4659
4660 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4661 current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
4662 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4663
4664 if (any_deleted)
4665 {
4666 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4667 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
4668 for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++)
4669 {
4670 const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix];
4671
4672 if (ix > 0)
4673 current_uiout->text (" ");
4674 current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
4675 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4676 }
4677 }
4678
4679 if (any_added)
4680 {
4681 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4682 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
4683 bool first = true;
4684 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
4685 {
4686 if (!first)
4687 current_uiout->text (" ");
4688 first = false;
4689 current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
4690 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4691 }
4692 }
4693 }
4694
4695 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4696 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4697 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4698 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4699 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4700 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4701 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4702 routine is one of:
4703
4704 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4705 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4706 code to print the location. An example is
4707 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4708 the location.
4709 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4710 to also print the location part of the message.
4711 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4712 don't require a location appended to the end.
4713 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4714 further info to be printed. */
4715
4716 enum print_stop_action
4717 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4718 {
4719 enum print_stop_action val;
4720
4721 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4722 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4723 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4724 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4725 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4726 {
4727 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4728 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4729 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4730 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4731 return val;
4732 }
4733
4734 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4735 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4736 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4737 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4738 {
4739 print_solib_event (0);
4740 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4741 }
4742
4743 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4744 with and nothing was printed. */
4745 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4746 }
4747
4748 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4749
4750 static bool
4751 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
4752 {
4753 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4754 bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
4755
4756 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4757 return res;
4758 }
4759
4760 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4761
4762 bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4763 : next (NULL),
4764 bp_location_at (bp_location_ref_ptr::new_reference (bl)),
4765 breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
4766 commands (NULL),
4767 print (0),
4768 stop (0),
4769 print_it (print_it_normal)
4770 {
4771 **bs_link_pointer = this;
4772 *bs_link_pointer = &next;
4773 }
4774
4775 bpstats::bpstats ()
4776 : next (NULL),
4777 breakpoint_at (NULL),
4778 commands (NULL),
4779 print (0),
4780 stop (0),
4781 print_it (print_it_normal)
4782 {
4783 }
4784 \f
4785 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4786 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4787
4788 int
4789 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4790 {
4791 bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4792 CORE_ADDR addr;
4793
4794 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4795 {
4796 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4797 as not triggered. */
4798 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
4799 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4800 {
4801 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4802
4803 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4804 }
4805
4806 return 0;
4807 }
4808
4809 if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_inferior ()->top_target (), &addr))
4810 {
4811 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4812 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4813 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
4814 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4815 {
4816 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4817
4818 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4819 }
4820
4821 return 1;
4822 }
4823
4824 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4825 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4826 triggered. */
4827
4828 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
4829 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4830 {
4831 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4832
4833 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4834 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
4835 {
4836 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4837 {
4838 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4839 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4840
4841 if (newaddr == start)
4842 {
4843 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4844 break;
4845 }
4846 }
4847 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4848 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range
4849 (current_inferior ()->top_target (), addr, loc->address,
4850 loc->length))
4851 {
4852 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4853 break;
4854 }
4855 }
4856 }
4857
4858 return 1;
4859 }
4860
4861 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4862 enum wp_check_result
4863 {
4864 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4865 WP_DELETED = 1,
4866
4867 /* The value has changed. */
4868 WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
4869
4870 /* The value has not changed. */
4871 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
4872
4873 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4874 WP_IGNORE = 4,
4875 };
4876
4877 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4878 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4879
4880 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4881 changed. */
4882
4883 static wp_check_result
4884 watchpoint_check (bpstat bs)
4885 {
4886 struct watchpoint *b;
4887 struct frame_info *fr;
4888 int within_current_scope;
4889
4890 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4891 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4892 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4893
4894 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4895 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4896 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4897 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4898 return WP_IGNORE;
4899
4900 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4901 within_current_scope = 1;
4902 else
4903 {
4904 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4905 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4906 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4907
4908 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4909 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4910 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4911 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4912 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4913 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4914 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4915 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4916 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4917 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4918 return WP_IGNORE;
4919
4920 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4921 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4922
4923 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4924 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4925 if (within_current_scope)
4926 {
4927 struct symbol *function;
4928
4929 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4930 if (function == NULL
4931 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
4932 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
4933 within_current_scope = 0;
4934 }
4935
4936 if (within_current_scope)
4937 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4938 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4939 the user. */
4940 select_frame (fr);
4941 }
4942
4943 if (within_current_scope)
4944 {
4945 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4946 time before we return to the command level and call
4947 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4948 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4949
4950 struct value *mark;
4951 struct value *new_val;
4952
4953 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4954 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4955 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4956 a mask watchpoint. */
4957 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4958
4959 mark = value_mark ();
4960 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &new_val,
4961 NULL, NULL, false);
4962
4963 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
4964 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
4965
4966 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4967 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4968 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4969 not what we want. */
4970 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4971 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (),
4972 new_val)))
4973 {
4974 bs->old_val = b->val;
4975 b->val = release_value (new_val);
4976 b->val_valid = true;
4977 if (new_val != NULL)
4978 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4979 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4980 }
4981 else
4982 {
4983 /* Nothing changed. */
4984 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4985 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4986 }
4987 }
4988 else
4989 {
4990 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4991 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4992 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4993 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4994 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4995 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4996 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4997 the first value assigned). */
4998 /* We print all the stop information in
4999 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
5000 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
5001 already. So we have no choice but print the information
5002 here. */
5003
5004 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5005 {
5006 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5007
5008 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5009 uiout->field_string
5010 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
5011 uiout->message ("\nWatchpoint %pF deleted because the program has "
5012 "left the block in\n"
5013 "which its expression is valid.\n",
5014 signed_field ("wpnum", b->number));
5015 }
5016
5017 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
5018 b->commands = NULL;
5019 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5020
5021 return WP_DELETED;
5022 }
5023 }
5024
5025 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
5026 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
5027 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
5028
5029 static int
5030 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
5031 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5032 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5033 {
5034 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
5035
5036 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
5037 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5038
5039 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5040 }
5041
5042 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
5043 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
5044
5045 static void
5046 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
5047 {
5048 const struct bp_location *bl;
5049 struct watchpoint *b;
5050
5051 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5052 bl = bs->bp_location_at.get ();
5053 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5054 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5055 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5056
5057 {
5058 int must_check_value = 0;
5059
5060 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5061 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5062 watched value. */
5063 must_check_value = 1;
5064 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5065 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5066 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5067 this watchpoint. */
5068 must_check_value = 1;
5069 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5070 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5071 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5072 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5073 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5074 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5075 must_check_value = 1;
5076
5077 if (must_check_value)
5078 {
5079 wp_check_result e;
5080
5081 try
5082 {
5083 e = watchpoint_check (bs);
5084 }
5085 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
5086 {
5087 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5088 "Error evaluating expression "
5089 "for watchpoint %d\n",
5090 b->number);
5091
5092 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5093 {
5094 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5095 b->number);
5096 }
5097 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5098 e = WP_DELETED;
5099 }
5100
5101 switch (e)
5102 {
5103 case WP_DELETED:
5104 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5105 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5106 /* Stop. */
5107 break;
5108 case WP_IGNORE:
5109 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5110 bs->stop = 0;
5111 break;
5112 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5113 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5114 {
5115 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5116
5117 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5118 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5119 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5120 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5121 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5122 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5123 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5124 old value.
5125
5126 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5127 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5128 happen:
5129
5130 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5131 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5132 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5133 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5134
5135 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5136 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5137 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5138 watchpoint.
5139
5140 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5141 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5142 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5143 changes. This still gives false positives when
5144 the program writes the same value to memory as
5145 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5146 it for a read), but it's much better than
5147 nothing. */
5148
5149 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5150
5151 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5152 {
5153 for (breakpoint *other_b : all_breakpoints ())
5154 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5155 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5156 {
5157 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5158 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5159
5160 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5161 == watch_triggered_yes)
5162 {
5163 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5164 break;
5165 }
5166 }
5167 }
5168
5169 if (other_write_watchpoint
5170 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5171 {
5172 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5173 and the value changed since the last time we
5174 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5175 Ignore it. */
5176 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5177 bs->stop = 0;
5178 }
5179 }
5180 break;
5181 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5182 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5183 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5184 {
5185 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5186 the value hasn't changed. */
5187 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5188 bs->stop = 0;
5189 }
5190 /* Stop. */
5191 break;
5192 default:
5193 /* Can't happen. */
5194 break;
5195 }
5196 }
5197 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5198 {
5199 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5200 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5201 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5202 anything for this watchpoint. */
5203 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5204 bs->stop = 0;
5205 }
5206 }
5207 }
5208
5209 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5210 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5211 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5212 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5213
5214 static void
5215 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, thread_info *thread)
5216 {
5217 const struct bp_location *bl;
5218 struct breakpoint *b;
5219 /* Assume stop. */
5220 bool condition_result = true;
5221 struct expression *cond;
5222
5223 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5224
5225 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5226 bl = bs->bp_location_at.get ();
5227 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5228 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5229 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5230
5231 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5232 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5233 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5234
5235 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5236 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5237 {
5238 bs->stop = 0;
5239 return;
5240 }
5241
5242 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5243 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5244 thread/task. */
5245 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num)
5246 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread)))
5247 {
5248 bs->stop = 0;
5249 return;
5250 }
5251
5252 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5253 implemented. */
5254 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5255
5256 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5257 {
5258 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5259
5260 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5261 }
5262 else
5263 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5264
5265 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5266 {
5267 int within_current_scope = 1;
5268 struct watchpoint * w;
5269
5270 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5271 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5272 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5273 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5274 function call. */
5275 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5276
5277 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5278 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5279 else
5280 w = NULL;
5281
5282 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5283 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5284 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5285 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5286 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5287 call site. */
5288 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5289 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5290 else
5291 {
5292 struct frame_info *frame;
5293
5294 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5295 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5296 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5297 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5298 really matter which instantiation of the function
5299 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5300 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5301 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5302 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5303 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5304 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5305 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5306 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5307 intuitive. */
5308 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5309 if (frame != NULL)
5310 select_frame (frame);
5311 else
5312 within_current_scope = 0;
5313 }
5314 if (within_current_scope)
5315 {
5316 try
5317 {
5318 condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
5319 }
5320 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
5321 {
5322 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5323 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5324 }
5325 }
5326 else
5327 {
5328 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5329 "in the current scope"));
5330 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5331 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5332 }
5333 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5334 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5335 }
5336
5337 if (cond && !condition_result)
5338 {
5339 bs->stop = 0;
5340 }
5341 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5342 {
5343 b->ignore_count--;
5344 bs->stop = 0;
5345 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5346 ++(b->hit_count);
5347 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5348 }
5349 }
5350
5351 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5352 on the current target. */
5353
5354 static int
5355 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5356 {
5357 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5358 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5359 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5360 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5361 }
5362
5363 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5364
5365 bpstat
5366 build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5367 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5368 {
5369 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5370
5371 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
5372 {
5373 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5374 continue;
5375
5376 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
5377 {
5378 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5379 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5380 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5381 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5382 checked all locations already. */
5383 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5384 break;
5385
5386 if (!bl->enabled || bl->disabled_by_cond || bl->shlib_disabled)
5387 continue;
5388
5389 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5390 continue;
5391
5392 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5393 matches. */
5394
5395 bpstat bs = new bpstats (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5396 explain stop. */
5397
5398 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5399 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5400 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5401 bs->stop = 1;
5402 bs->print = 1;
5403
5404 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5405 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5406 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5407 iteration. */
5408 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5409 {
5410 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5411
5412 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5413 }
5414 }
5415 }
5416
5417 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5418 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5419 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5420 {
5421 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
5422 {
5423 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5424 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5425 {
5426 bpstat bs = new bpstats (loc, &bs_link);
5427 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5428 bs->stop = 0;
5429 bs->print = 0;
5430 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5431 }
5432 }
5433 }
5434
5435 return bs_head;
5436 }
5437
5438 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5439
5440 bpstat
5441 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
5442 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread,
5443 const struct target_waitstatus *ws,
5444 bpstat stop_chain)
5445 {
5446 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5447 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5448 bpstat bs_head = stop_chain;
5449 bpstat bs;
5450 int need_remove_insert;
5451 int removed_any;
5452
5453 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5454 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5455 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5456 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5457 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5458 inferior function calls. */
5459 if (bs_head == NULL)
5460 bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5461
5462 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5463 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5464 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5465 "catch unload". */
5466 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5467 {
5468 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5469 {
5470 handle_solib_event ();
5471 break;
5472 }
5473 }
5474
5475 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5476 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5477 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5478
5479 removed_any = 0;
5480
5481 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5482 {
5483 if (!bs->stop)
5484 continue;
5485
5486 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5487 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5488 if (bs->stop)
5489 {
5490 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread);
5491
5492 if (bs->stop)
5493 {
5494 ++(b->hit_count);
5495 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5496
5497 /* We will stop here. */
5498 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5499 {
5500 --(b->enable_count);
5501 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5502 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5503 removed_any = 1;
5504 }
5505 if (b->silent)
5506 bs->print = 0;
5507 bs->commands = b->commands;
5508 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5509 ? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
5510 bs->print = 0;
5511
5512 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5513 }
5514
5515 }
5516
5517 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5518 print. */
5519 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5520 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5521 }
5522
5523 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5524 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5525 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5526 done later. */
5527 need_remove_insert = 0;
5528 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5529 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5530 if (!bs->stop
5531 && bs->breakpoint_at
5532 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5533 {
5534 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5535
5536 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5537 need_remove_insert = 1;
5538 }
5539
5540 if (need_remove_insert)
5541 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5542 else if (removed_any)
5543 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5544
5545 return bs_head;
5546 }
5547
5548 static void
5549 handle_jit_event (CORE_ADDR address)
5550 {
5551 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5552
5553 infrun_debug_printf ("handling bp_jit_event");
5554
5555 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5556 breakpoint_re_set. */
5557 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5558
5559 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (get_current_frame ());
5560 /* This event is caused by a breakpoint set in `jit_breakpoint_re_set`,
5561 thus it is expected that its objectfile can be found through
5562 minimal symbol lookup. If it doesn't work (and assert fails), it
5563 most likely means that `jit_breakpoint_re_set` was changes and this
5564 function needs to be updated too. */
5565 bound_minimal_symbol jit_bp_sym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (address);
5566 gdb_assert (jit_bp_sym.objfile != nullptr);
5567 jit_event_handler (gdbarch, jit_bp_sym.objfile);
5568
5569 target_terminal::inferior ();
5570 }
5571
5572 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5573
5574 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5575
5576 struct bpstat_what
5577 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5578 {
5579 struct bpstat_what retval;
5580 bpstat bs;
5581
5582 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5583 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5584 retval.is_longjmp = false;
5585
5586 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5587 {
5588 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5589 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5590 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5591 enum bptype bptype;
5592
5593 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5594 {
5595 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5596 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5597 bptype = bp_none;
5598 }
5599 else
5600 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5601
5602 switch (bptype)
5603 {
5604 case bp_none:
5605 break;
5606 case bp_breakpoint:
5607 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5608 case bp_single_step:
5609 case bp_until:
5610 case bp_finish:
5611 case bp_shlib_event:
5612 if (bs->stop)
5613 {
5614 if (bs->print)
5615 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5616 else
5617 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5618 }
5619 else
5620 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5621 break;
5622 case bp_watchpoint:
5623 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5624 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5625 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5626 if (bs->stop)
5627 {
5628 if (bs->print)
5629 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5630 else
5631 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5632 }
5633 else
5634 {
5635 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5636 This requires no further action. */
5637 }
5638 break;
5639 case bp_longjmp:
5640 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5641 case bp_exception:
5642 if (bs->stop)
5643 {
5644 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5645 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5646 }
5647 else
5648 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5649 break;
5650 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5651 case bp_exception_resume:
5652 if (bs->stop)
5653 {
5654 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5655 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5656 }
5657 else
5658 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5659 break;
5660 case bp_step_resume:
5661 if (bs->stop)
5662 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5663 else
5664 {
5665 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5666 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5667 }
5668 break;
5669 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5670 if (bs->stop)
5671 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5672 else
5673 {
5674 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5675 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5676 }
5677 break;
5678 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5679 case bp_thread_event:
5680 case bp_overlay_event:
5681 case bp_longjmp_master:
5682 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5683 case bp_exception_master:
5684 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5685 break;
5686 case bp_catchpoint:
5687 if (bs->stop)
5688 {
5689 if (bs->print)
5690 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5691 else
5692 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5693 }
5694 else
5695 {
5696 /* Some catchpoints are implemented with breakpoints.
5697 For those, we need to step over the breakpoint. */
5698 if (bs->bp_location_at->loc_type != bp_loc_other)
5699 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5700 }
5701 break;
5702 case bp_jit_event:
5703 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5704 break;
5705 case bp_call_dummy:
5706 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5707 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5708 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5709 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5710 break;
5711 case bp_std_terminate:
5712 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5713 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5714 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5715 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5716 break;
5717 case bp_tracepoint:
5718 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5719 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5720 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5721 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5722 out already. */
5723 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5724 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5725 break;
5726 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5727 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5728 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5729 break;
5730 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5731 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5732 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5733 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5734 break;
5735
5736 case bp_dprintf:
5737 if (bs->stop)
5738 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5739 else
5740 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5741 break;
5742
5743 default:
5744 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5745 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5746 }
5747
5748 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5749 }
5750
5751 return retval;
5752 }
5753
5754 void
5755 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
5756 {
5757 bpstat bs;
5758
5759 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5760 {
5761 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5762
5763 if (b == NULL)
5764 continue;
5765 switch (b->type)
5766 {
5767 case bp_jit_event:
5768 handle_jit_event (bs->bp_location_at->address);
5769 break;
5770 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5771 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5772 break;
5773 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5774 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5775 break;
5776 }
5777 }
5778 }
5779
5780 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5781
5782 bool
5783 bpstat_should_step ()
5784 {
5785 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
5786 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5787 return true;
5788
5789 return false;
5790 }
5791
5792 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5793
5794 bool
5795 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5796 {
5797 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5798 if (bs->stop)
5799 return true;
5800
5801 return false;
5802 }
5803
5804 \f
5805
5806 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5807 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5808 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5809
5810 static char *
5811 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5812 {
5813 static char wrap_indent[80];
5814 int i, total_width, width, align;
5815 const char *text;
5816
5817 total_width = 0;
5818 for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5819 {
5820 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5821 {
5822 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5823 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5824 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5825
5826 return wrap_indent;
5827 }
5828
5829 total_width += width + 1;
5830 }
5831
5832 return NULL;
5833 }
5834
5835 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5836 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5837
5838 "host": Host evals condition.
5839 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5840 "target": Target evals condition.
5841 */
5842
5843 static const char *
5844 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5845 {
5846 char host_evals = 0;
5847 char target_evals = 0;
5848
5849 if (!b)
5850 return NULL;
5851
5852 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5853 return NULL;
5854
5855 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5856 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5857 return condition_evaluation_host;
5858
5859 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
5860 {
5861 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5862 target_evals++;
5863 else
5864 host_evals++;
5865 }
5866
5867 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5868 return condition_evaluation_both;
5869 else if (target_evals)
5870 return condition_evaluation_target;
5871 else
5872 return condition_evaluation_host;
5873 }
5874
5875 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5876 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5877
5878 static const char *
5879 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5880 {
5881 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5882 return NULL;
5883
5884 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5885 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5886 return condition_evaluation_host;
5887
5888 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5889 return condition_evaluation_target;
5890 else
5891 return condition_evaluation_host;
5892 }
5893
5894 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5895
5896 static void
5897 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5898 struct bp_location *loc)
5899 {
5900 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5901
5902 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
5903
5904 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5905 loc = NULL;
5906
5907 if (loc != NULL)
5908 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5909
5910 if (b->display_canonical)
5911 uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5912 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5913 {
5914 const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
5915
5916 if (sym)
5917 {
5918 uiout->text ("in ");
5919 uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (),
5920 function_name_style.style ());
5921 uiout->text (" ");
5922 uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5923 uiout->text ("at ");
5924 }
5925 uiout->field_string ("file",
5926 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab),
5927 file_name_style.style ());
5928 uiout->text (":");
5929
5930 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5931 uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5932
5933 uiout->field_signed ("line", loc->line_number);
5934 }
5935 else if (loc)
5936 {
5937 string_file stb;
5938
5939 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
5940 demangle, "");
5941 uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
5942 }
5943 else
5944 {
5945 uiout->field_string ("pending",
5946 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5947 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5948 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5949 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5950 if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
5951 {
5952 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
5953 uiout->text (",");
5954 else
5955 uiout->text (" ");
5956 uiout->text (b->extra_string);
5957 }
5958 }
5959
5960 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5961 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5962 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5963 {
5964 uiout->text (" (");
5965 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5966 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5967 uiout->text (")");
5968 }
5969 }
5970
5971 static const char *
5972 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5973 {
5974 struct ep_type_description
5975 {
5976 enum bptype type;
5977 const char *description;
5978 };
5979 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
5980 {
5981 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
5982 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
5983 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
5984 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
5985 {bp_until, "until"},
5986 {bp_finish, "finish"},
5987 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
5988 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
5989 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
5990 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
5991 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
5992 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
5993 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5994 {bp_exception, "exception"},
5995 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
5996 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
5997 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
5998 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
5999 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
6000 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
6001 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
6002 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
6003 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
6004 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
6005 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
6006 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
6007 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
6008 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
6009 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
6010 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
6011 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
6012 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
6013 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
6014 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
6015 };
6016
6017 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
6018 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
6019 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6020 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
6021 (int) type);
6022
6023 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
6024 }
6025
6026 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
6027 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
6028
6029 static void
6030 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
6031 const char *field_name,
6032 const std::vector<int> &inf_nums,
6033 int mi_only)
6034 {
6035 int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
6036
6037 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6038 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
6039 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
6040 return;
6041
6042 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
6043
6044 for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++)
6045 {
6046 if (is_mi)
6047 {
6048 char mi_group[10];
6049
6050 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]);
6051 uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
6052 }
6053 else
6054 {
6055 if (i == 0)
6056 uiout->text (" inf ");
6057 else
6058 uiout->text (", ");
6059
6060 uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i]));
6061 }
6062 }
6063 }
6064
6065 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. If RAW_LOC, print raw breakpoint locations
6066 instead of going via breakpoint_ops::print_one. This makes "maint
6067 info breakpoints" show the software breakpoint locations of
6068 catchpoints, which are considered internal implementation
6069 detail. */
6070
6071 static void
6072 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6073 struct bp_location *loc,
6074 int loc_number,
6075 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6076 int allflag, bool raw_loc)
6077 {
6078 struct command_line *l;
6079 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6080
6081 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6082 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6083 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6084 struct value_print_options opts;
6085
6086 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6087
6088 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6089 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6090 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6091 if (loc == NULL
6092 && (b->loc != NULL
6093 && (b->loc->next != NULL
6094 || !b->loc->enabled || b->loc->disabled_by_cond)))
6095 header_of_multiple = 1;
6096 if (loc == NULL)
6097 loc = b->loc;
6098
6099 annotate_record ();
6100
6101 /* 1 */
6102 annotate_field (0);
6103 if (part_of_multiple)
6104 uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6105 else
6106 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
6107
6108 /* 2 */
6109 annotate_field (1);
6110 if (part_of_multiple)
6111 uiout->field_skip ("type");
6112 else
6113 uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
6114
6115 /* 3 */
6116 annotate_field (2);
6117 if (part_of_multiple)
6118 uiout->field_skip ("disp");
6119 else
6120 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6121
6122 /* 4 */
6123 annotate_field (3);
6124 /* For locations that are disabled because of an invalid condition,
6125 display "N*" on CLI, where "*" refers to a footnote below the
6126 table. For MI, simply display a "N" without a footnote. */
6127 const char *N = (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) ? "N" : "N*";
6128 if (part_of_multiple)
6129 uiout->field_string ("enabled", (loc->disabled_by_cond ? N
6130 : (loc->enabled ? "y" : "n")));
6131 else
6132 uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6133
6134 /* 5 and 6 */
6135 if (!raw_loc && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6136 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6137 else
6138 {
6139 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6140 {
6141 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6142
6143 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6144 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6145 is relatively readable). */
6146 if (opts.addressprint)
6147 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
6148 annotate_field (5);
6149 uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string);
6150 }
6151 else if (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b)
6152 || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b))
6153 {
6154 if (opts.addressprint)
6155 {
6156 annotate_field (4);
6157 if (header_of_multiple)
6158 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>",
6159 metadata_style.style ());
6160 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6161 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>",
6162 metadata_style.style ());
6163 else
6164 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
6165 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6166 }
6167 annotate_field (5);
6168 if (!header_of_multiple)
6169 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6170 if (b->loc)
6171 *last_loc = b->loc;
6172 }
6173 }
6174
6175 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6176 {
6177 std::vector<int> inf_nums;
6178 int mi_only = 1;
6179
6180 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
6181 {
6182 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6183 inf_nums.push_back (inf->num);
6184 }
6185
6186 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6187 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6188 if (allflag
6189 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6190 && (program_spaces.size () > 1
6191 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6192 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6193 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6194 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6195 mi_only = 0;
6196 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only);
6197 }
6198
6199 if (!part_of_multiple)
6200 {
6201 if (b->thread != -1)
6202 {
6203 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6204 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6205 uiout->text (" thread ");
6206 uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread);
6207 }
6208 else if (b->task != 0)
6209 {
6210 uiout->text (" task ");
6211 uiout->field_signed ("task", b->task);
6212 }
6213 }
6214
6215 uiout->text ("\n");
6216
6217 if (!part_of_multiple)
6218 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6219
6220 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6221 {
6222 annotate_field (6);
6223 uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6224 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6225 the frame ID. */
6226 uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
6227 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6228 uiout->text ("\n");
6229 }
6230
6231 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6232 {
6233 annotate_field (7);
6234 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6235 uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6236 else
6237 uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
6238 uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string);
6239
6240 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6241 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6242 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6243 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6244 == condition_evaluation_target)
6245 {
6246 uiout->message (" (%pF evals)",
6247 string_field ("evaluated-by",
6248 bp_condition_evaluator (b)));
6249 }
6250 uiout->text ("\n");
6251 }
6252
6253 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6254 {
6255 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6256 uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6257 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6258 uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread);
6259 else
6260 {
6261 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6262
6263 uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6264 }
6265 uiout->text ("\n");
6266 }
6267
6268 if (!part_of_multiple)
6269 {
6270 if (b->hit_count)
6271 {
6272 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6273 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6274 uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6275 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6276 uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
6277 else
6278 uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6279 uiout->text (" already hit ");
6280 uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count);
6281 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6282 uiout->text (" time\n");
6283 else
6284 uiout->text (" times\n");
6285 }
6286 else
6287 {
6288 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6289 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6290 uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count);
6291 }
6292 }
6293
6294 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6295 {
6296 annotate_field (8);
6297 uiout->message ("\tignore next %pF hits\n",
6298 signed_field ("ignore", b->ignore_count));
6299 }
6300
6301 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6302 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6303 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6304 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6305 {
6306 annotate_field (8);
6307 uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
6308 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6309 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6310 if (b->ignore_count)
6311 uiout->text ("additional ");
6312 else
6313 uiout->text ("next ");
6314 uiout->field_signed ("enable", b->enable_count);
6315 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6316 }
6317
6318 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6319 {
6320 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6321
6322 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6323 {
6324 uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6325 uiout->field_signed ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6326 uiout->text (" bytes\n");
6327 }
6328 }
6329
6330 l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
6331 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6332 {
6333 annotate_field (9);
6334 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
6335 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6336 }
6337
6338 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6339 {
6340 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6341
6342 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6343 {
6344 annotate_field (10);
6345 uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
6346 uiout->field_signed ("pass", t->pass_count);
6347 uiout->text (" \n");
6348 }
6349
6350 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6351 pending. */
6352 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6353 {
6354 annotate_field (11);
6355
6356 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6357 uiout->field_string ("installed",
6358 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6359 else
6360 {
6361 if (loc->inserted)
6362 uiout->text ("\t");
6363 else
6364 uiout->text ("\tnot ");
6365 uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
6366 }
6367 }
6368 }
6369
6370 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
6371 {
6372 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6373 {
6374 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6375
6376 uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string);
6377 }
6378 else if (b->location != NULL
6379 && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
6380 uiout->field_string ("original-location",
6381 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
6382 }
6383 }
6384
6385 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6386
6387 bool fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally = false;
6388
6389 static void
6390 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6391 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6392 int allflag)
6393 {
6394 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6395 bool use_fixed_output
6396 = (uiout->test_flags (fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output)
6397 || fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally);
6398
6399 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> bkpt_tuple_emitter (gdb::in_place, uiout, "bkpt");
6400 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag, false);
6401
6402 /* The mi2 broken format: the main breakpoint tuple ends here, the locations
6403 are outside. */
6404 if (!use_fixed_output)
6405 bkpt_tuple_emitter.reset ();
6406
6407 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6408 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6409 locations, if any. */
6410 if (b->ops == NULL
6411 || b->ops->print_one == NULL
6412 || allflag)
6413 {
6414 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6415 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6416 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6417 situation.
6418
6419 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6420 internally, that's not a property exposed to users.
6421
6422 Likewise, while catchpoints may be implemented with
6423 breakpoints (e.g., catch throw), that's not a property
6424 exposed to users. We do however display the internal
6425 breakpoint locations with "maint info breakpoints". */
6426 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6427 && (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b)
6428 || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b))
6429 && (allflag
6430 || (b->loc && (b->loc->next
6431 || !b->loc->enabled
6432 || b->loc->disabled_by_cond))))
6433 {
6434 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_list> locations_list;
6435
6436 /* For MI version <= 2, keep the behavior where GDB outputs an invalid
6437 MI record. For later versions, place breakpoint locations in a
6438 list. */
6439 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && use_fixed_output)
6440 locations_list.emplace (uiout, "locations");
6441
6442 int n = 1;
6443 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
6444 {
6445 ui_out_emit_tuple loc_tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
6446 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
6447 allflag, allflag);
6448 n++;
6449 }
6450 }
6451 }
6452 }
6453
6454 static int
6455 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6456 {
6457 int print_address_bits = 0;
6458
6459 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6460 address to print. */
6461 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6462 return 0;
6463
6464 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
6465 {
6466 int addr_bit;
6467
6468 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6469 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6470 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6471 }
6472
6473 return print_address_bits;
6474 }
6475
6476 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6477
6478 void
6479 print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
6480 {
6481 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6482 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6483 }
6484
6485 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6486 internal or momentary. */
6487
6488 int
6489 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6490 {
6491 return b->number > 0;
6492 }
6493
6494 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6495
6496 int
6497 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6498 {
6499 return b->loc == NULL;
6500 }
6501
6502 /* Print information on breakpoints (including watchpoints and tracepoints).
6503
6504 If non-NULL, BP_NUM_LIST is a list of numbers and number ranges as
6505 understood by number_or_range_parser. Only breakpoints included in this
6506 list are then printed.
6507
6508 If SHOW_INTERNAL is true, print internal breakpoints.
6509
6510 If FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6511 ones for which it returns true.
6512
6513 Return the total number of breakpoints listed. */
6514
6515 static int
6516 breakpoint_1 (const char *bp_num_list, bool show_internal,
6517 bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6518 {
6519 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6520 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6521 struct value_print_options opts;
6522 int print_address_bits = 0;
6523 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6524 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6525 bool has_disabled_by_cond_location = false;
6526
6527 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6528
6529 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6530 required for address fields. */
6531 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6532 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6533 {
6534 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6535 if (filter && !filter (b))
6536 continue;
6537
6538 /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6539 accept. Skip the others. */
6540 if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0')
6541 {
6542 if (show_internal && parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number)
6543 continue;
6544 if (!show_internal && !number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number))
6545 continue;
6546 }
6547
6548 if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6549 {
6550 int addr_bit, type_len;
6551
6552 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6553 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6554 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6555
6556 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6557 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6558 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6559
6560 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6561 }
6562 }
6563
6564 {
6565 ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
6566 opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
6567 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6568 "BreakpointTable");
6569
6570 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6571 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6572 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6573 annotate_field (0);
6574 uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6575 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6576 annotate_field (1);
6577 uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6578 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6579 annotate_field (2);
6580 uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6581 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6582 annotate_field (3);
6583 uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6584 if (opts.addressprint)
6585 {
6586 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6587 annotate_field (4);
6588 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6589 uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6590 else
6591 uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6592 }
6593 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6594 annotate_field (5);
6595 uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6596 uiout->table_body ();
6597 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6598 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6599
6600 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6601 {
6602 QUIT;
6603 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6604 if (filter && !filter (b))
6605 continue;
6606
6607 /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6608 accept. Skip the others. */
6609
6610 if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0')
6611 {
6612 if (show_internal) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6613 {
6614 if (parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number)
6615 continue;
6616 }
6617 else /* all others */
6618 {
6619 if (!number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number))
6620 continue;
6621 }
6622 }
6623 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6624 show_internal is set. */
6625 if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6626 {
6627 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, show_internal);
6628 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
6629 if (loc->disabled_by_cond)
6630 has_disabled_by_cond_location = true;
6631 }
6632 }
6633 }
6634
6635 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6636 {
6637 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6638 empty list. */
6639 if (!filter)
6640 {
6641 if (bp_num_list == NULL || *bp_num_list == '\0')
6642 uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6643 else
6644 uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6645 bp_num_list);
6646 }
6647 }
6648 else
6649 {
6650 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6651 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6652
6653 if (has_disabled_by_cond_location && !uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6654 uiout->message (_("(*): Breakpoint condition is invalid at this "
6655 "location.\n"));
6656 }
6657
6658 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6659 there have been breakpoints? */
6660 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6661
6662 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6663 }
6664
6665 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6666 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6667
6668 static void
6669 default_collect_info (void)
6670 {
6671 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6672
6673 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6674 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6675 not wanted. */
6676 if (!*default_collect)
6677 return;
6678
6679 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6680 actions. */
6681 uiout->text ("default collect ");
6682 uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
6683 uiout->text (" \n");
6684 }
6685
6686 static void
6687 info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6688 {
6689 breakpoint_1 (args, false, NULL);
6690
6691 default_collect_info ();
6692 }
6693
6694 static void
6695 info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6696 {
6697 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_watchpoint);
6698 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6699
6700 if (num_printed == 0)
6701 {
6702 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6703 uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6704 else
6705 uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6706 }
6707 }
6708
6709 static void
6710 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
6711 {
6712 breakpoint_1 (args, true, NULL);
6713
6714 default_collect_info ();
6715 }
6716
6717 static int
6718 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6719 struct program_space *pspace,
6720 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6721 {
6722 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
6723 {
6724 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6725 && bl->address == pc
6726 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6727 return 1;
6728 }
6729 return 0;
6730 }
6731
6732 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6733 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6734 address spaces. */
6735
6736 static void
6737 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6738 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6739 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6740 {
6741 int others = 0;
6742
6743 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6744 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6745 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6746
6747 if (others > 0)
6748 {
6749 if (others == 1)
6750 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6751 else /* if (others == ???) */
6752 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6753 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6754 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6755 {
6756 others--;
6757 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6758 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6759 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6760 else if (b->thread != -1)
6761 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6762 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6763 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6764 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6765 ? " (disabled)"
6766 : ""),
6767 (others > 1) ? ","
6768 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6769 }
6770 current_uiout->message (_("also set at pc %ps.\n"),
6771 styled_string (address_style.style (),
6772 paddress (gdbarch, pc)));
6773 }
6774 }
6775 \f
6776
6777 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of LOC.
6778 For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members are
6779 irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to
6780 other addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6781
6782 More specifically, software watchpoints and catchpoints that are
6783 not backed by breakpoints always have a zero valued location
6784 address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of these types
6785 to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint location at address
6786 zero. */
6787
6788 static bool
6789 bl_address_is_meaningful (bp_location *loc)
6790 {
6791 return loc->loc_type != bp_loc_other;
6792 }
6793
6794 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6795 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6796
6797 static int
6798 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6799 struct bp_location *loc2)
6800 {
6801 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6802 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6803
6804 /* Both of them must exist. */
6805 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6806 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6807
6808 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6809 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6810 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6811 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6812 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6813 other watchpoint. */
6814 if ((w1->cond_exp
6815 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6816 loc1->length,
6817 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6818 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
6819 || (w2->cond_exp
6820 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6821 loc2->length,
6822 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6823 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
6824 return 0;
6825
6826 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6827 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6828 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6829 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6830 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6831 become hw_access locations later. */
6832 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6833 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6834 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6835 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6836 }
6837
6838 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6839
6840 int
6841 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6842 const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6843 {
6844 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6845 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6846 && addr1 == addr2);
6847 }
6848
6849 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6850 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6851 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6852 space doesn't really matter. */
6853
6854 static int
6855 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
6856 CORE_ADDR addr1,
6857 int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
6858 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6859 {
6860 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6861 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6862 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6863 }
6864
6865 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6866 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6867 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6868 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6869
6870 static int
6871 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6872 const address_space *aspace,
6873 CORE_ADDR addr)
6874 {
6875 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6876 aspace, addr)
6877 || (bl->length
6878 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6879 bl->address, bl->length,
6880 aspace, addr)));
6881 }
6882
6883 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6884 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6885 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6886 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6887 doesn't really matter. */
6888
6889 static int
6890 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
6891 const address_space *aspace,
6892 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
6893 {
6894 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6895 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
6896 {
6897 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
6898
6899 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
6900 return 1;
6901 }
6902 return 0;
6903 }
6904
6905 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6906 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6907 true, otherwise returns false. */
6908
6909 static int
6910 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6911 struct bp_location *loc2)
6912 {
6913 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6914 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6915 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6916 different locations. */
6917 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6918 else
6919 return 0;
6920 }
6921
6922 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6923 (bl_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent
6924 the same location. If SW_HW_BPS_MATCH is true, then software
6925 breakpoint locations and hardware breakpoint locations match,
6926 otherwise they don't. */
6927
6928 static int
6929 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6930 struct bp_location *loc2,
6931 bool sw_hw_bps_match)
6932 {
6933 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6934
6935 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6936 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6937 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6938
6939 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6940 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6941
6942 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6943 return 0;
6944 else if (hw_point1)
6945 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6946 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6947 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6948 else
6949 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged
6950 breakpoints. Keep this in sync with
6951 bp_location_is_less_than. */
6952 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6953 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6954 && (loc1->loc_type == loc2->loc_type || sw_hw_bps_match)
6955 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6956 }
6957
6958 static void
6959 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6960 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6961 {
6962 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6963 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6964 char astr1[64];
6965 char astr2[64];
6966
6967 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6968 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6969 if (have_bnum)
6970 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6971 bnum, astr1, astr2);
6972 else
6973 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
6974 }
6975
6976 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6977 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6978 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6979 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6980
6981 static CORE_ADDR
6982 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6983 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
6984 {
6985 if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
6986 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6987 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
6988 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
6989 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
6990 {
6991 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6992 have their addresses modified. */
6993 return bpaddr;
6994 }
6995 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
6996 {
6997 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
6998 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
6999 applies to this address, then it should have already been
7000 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
7001 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
7002 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
7003 return bpaddr;
7004 }
7005 else
7006 {
7007 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr;
7008
7009 if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
7010 {
7011 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
7012 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
7013 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
7014 }
7015
7016 adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr);
7017
7018 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
7019 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
7020 is required. */
7021 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
7022 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
7023
7024 return adjusted_bpaddr;
7025 }
7026 }
7027
7028 static bp_loc_type
7029 bp_location_from_bp_type (bptype type)
7030 {
7031 switch (type)
7032 {
7033 case bp_breakpoint:
7034 case bp_single_step:
7035 case bp_until:
7036 case bp_finish:
7037 case bp_longjmp:
7038 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7039 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7040 case bp_exception:
7041 case bp_exception_resume:
7042 case bp_step_resume:
7043 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7044 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7045 case bp_call_dummy:
7046 case bp_std_terminate:
7047 case bp_shlib_event:
7048 case bp_thread_event:
7049 case bp_overlay_event:
7050 case bp_jit_event:
7051 case bp_longjmp_master:
7052 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7053 case bp_exception_master:
7054 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7055 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7056 case bp_dprintf:
7057 return bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7058 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7059 return bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7060 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7061 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7062 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7063 return bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7064 case bp_watchpoint:
7065 case bp_catchpoint:
7066 case bp_tracepoint:
7067 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7068 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7069 return bp_loc_other;
7070 default:
7071 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7072 }
7073 }
7074
7075 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner, bp_loc_type type)
7076 {
7077 this->owner = owner;
7078 this->cond_bytecode = NULL;
7079 this->shlib_disabled = 0;
7080 this->enabled = 1;
7081 this->disabled_by_cond = false;
7082
7083 this->loc_type = type;
7084
7085 if (this->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
7086 || this->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
7087 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (this);
7088
7089 incref ();
7090 }
7091
7092 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner)
7093 : bp_location::bp_location (owner,
7094 bp_location_from_bp_type (owner->type))
7095 {
7096 }
7097
7098 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7099
7100 static struct bp_location *
7101 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7102 {
7103 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7104 }
7105
7106 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7107 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7108
7109 static void
7110 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7111 {
7112 bp_location_ref_policy::decref (*blp);
7113 *blp = NULL;
7114 }
7115
7116 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7117
7118 static breakpoint *
7119 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
7120 {
7121 struct breakpoint *b1;
7122 struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
7123
7124 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7125 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7126
7127 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7128 if (b1 == 0)
7129 breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
7130 else
7131 {
7132 while (b1->next)
7133 b1 = b1->next;
7134 b1->next = b.release ();
7135 }
7136
7137 return result;
7138 }
7139
7140 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7141
7142 static void
7143 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7144 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7145 enum bptype bptype,
7146 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7147 {
7148 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7149
7150 b->ops = ops;
7151 b->type = bptype;
7152 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7153 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7154 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7155 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7156 }
7157
7158 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7159 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7160
7161 static struct breakpoint *
7162 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7163 enum bptype bptype,
7164 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7165 {
7166 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7167
7168 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7169 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7170 }
7171
7172 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
7173
7174 static void
7175 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
7176 {
7177 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7178
7179 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7180 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7181 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7182 {
7183 const char *function_name;
7184
7185 if (loc->msymbol != NULL
7186 && (MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_text_gnu_ifunc
7187 || MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_data_gnu_ifunc))
7188 {
7189 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7190
7191 function_name = loc->msymbol->linkage_name ();
7192
7193 if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7194 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7195 {
7196 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7197 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7198 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7199 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7200 breakpoint. */
7201 loc->related_address = loc->address;
7202 }
7203 }
7204 else
7205 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL);
7206
7207 if (function_name)
7208 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7209 }
7210 }
7211
7212 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7213 struct gdbarch *
7214 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7215 {
7216 if (sal.section)
7217 return sal.section->objfile->arch ();
7218 if (sal.symtab)
7219 return SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab)->arch ();
7220
7221 return NULL;
7222 }
7223
7224 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7225 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7226 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7227
7228 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7229 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7230 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7231
7232 static void
7233 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7234 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7235 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7236 {
7237 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7238
7239 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7240
7241 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7242 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7243
7244 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7245 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7246 program space. */
7247 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7248 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7249 }
7250
7251 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7252 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7253 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7254 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7255 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7256 is also returned as the value of this function.
7257
7258 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7259 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7260 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7261 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7262 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7263 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7264 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7265
7266 struct breakpoint *
7267 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7268 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7269 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7270 {
7271 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7272
7273 init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7274 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7275 }
7276
7277 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7278 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7279 initiated the operation. */
7280
7281 void
7282 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7283 {
7284 int thread = tp->global_num;
7285
7286 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7287 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7288 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7289 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7290 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7291 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7292 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7293 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7294 {
7295 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7296 struct breakpoint *clone;
7297
7298 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7299 after their removal. */
7300 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7301 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7302 clone->thread = thread;
7303 }
7304
7305 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7306 }
7307
7308 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7309 void
7310 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7311 {
7312 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7313 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7314 {
7315 if (b->thread == thread)
7316 delete_breakpoint (b);
7317 }
7318 }
7319
7320 void
7321 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7322 {
7323 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7324 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7325 {
7326 if (b->thread == thread)
7327 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7328 }
7329 }
7330
7331 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7332 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7333 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7334 breakpoints. */
7335
7336 struct breakpoint *
7337 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7338 {
7339 breakpoint *retval = nullptr;
7340
7341 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7342 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7343 {
7344 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7345
7346 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7347 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7348 1);
7349 new_b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
7350
7351 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7352
7353 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7354 if (retval == NULL)
7355 retval = new_b;
7356 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7357 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7358 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7359 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7360 }
7361
7362 return retval;
7363 }
7364
7365 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7366 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7367 stack.
7368
7369 If the unwind fails then there is not sufficient information to discard
7370 dummy frames. In this case, elide the clean up and the dummy frames will
7371 be cleaned up next time this function is called from a location where
7372 unwinding is possible. */
7373
7374 void
7375 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7376 {
7377 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7378
7379 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7380 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7381 {
7382 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7383
7384 /* Find the bp_call_dummy breakpoint in the list of breakpoints
7385 chained off b->related_breakpoint. */
7386 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7387 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7388
7389 /* If there was no bp_call_dummy breakpoint then there's nothing
7390 more to do. Or, if the dummy frame associated with the
7391 bp_call_dummy is still on the stack then we need to leave this
7392 bp_call_dummy in place. */
7393 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7394 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7395 continue;
7396
7397 /* We didn't find the dummy frame on the stack, this could be
7398 because we have longjmp'd to a stack frame that is previous to
7399 the dummy frame, or it could be because the stack unwind is
7400 broken at some point between the longjmp frame and the dummy
7401 frame.
7402
7403 Next we figure out why the stack unwind stopped. If it looks
7404 like the unwind is complete then we assume the dummy frame has
7405 been jumped over, however, if the unwind stopped for an
7406 unexpected reason then we assume the stack unwind is currently
7407 broken, and that we will (eventually) return to the dummy
7408 frame.
7409
7410 It might be tempting to consider using frame_id_inner here, but
7411 that is not safe. There is no guarantee that the stack frames
7412 we are looking at here are even on the same stack as the
7413 original dummy frame, hence frame_id_inner can't be used. See
7414 the comments on frame_id_inner for more details. */
7415 bool unwind_finished_unexpectedly = false;
7416 for (struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame (); fi != nullptr; )
7417 {
7418 struct frame_info *prev = get_prev_frame (fi);
7419 if (prev == nullptr)
7420 {
7421 /* FI is the last stack frame. Why did this frame not
7422 unwind further? */
7423 auto stop_reason = get_frame_unwind_stop_reason (fi);
7424 if (stop_reason != UNWIND_NO_REASON
7425 && stop_reason != UNWIND_OUTERMOST)
7426 unwind_finished_unexpectedly = true;
7427 }
7428 fi = prev;
7429 }
7430 if (unwind_finished_unexpectedly)
7431 continue;
7432
7433 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp);
7434
7435 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7436 {
7437 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7438 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7439 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7440 }
7441 delete_breakpoint (b);
7442 }
7443 }
7444
7445 void
7446 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7447 {
7448 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7449 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7450 {
7451 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7452 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7453 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7454 }
7455 }
7456
7457 void
7458 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7459 {
7460 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7461 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7462 {
7463 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7464 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7465 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7466 }
7467 }
7468
7469 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7470 master breakpoint. */
7471 void
7472 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7473 {
7474 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7475 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7476 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7477 {
7478 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7479 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7480 }
7481 }
7482
7483 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7484 void
7485 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7486 {
7487 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7488 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7489 delete_breakpoint (b);
7490 }
7491
7492 struct breakpoint *
7493 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7494 {
7495 struct breakpoint *b;
7496
7497 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7498 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7499
7500 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7501 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7502 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7503
7504 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7505
7506 return b;
7507 }
7508
7509 struct lang_and_radix
7510 {
7511 enum language lang;
7512 int radix;
7513 };
7514
7515 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7516
7517 struct breakpoint *
7518 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7519 {
7520 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7521 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7522 }
7523
7524 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7525
7526 void
7527 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7528 {
7529 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7530 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7531 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7532 delete_breakpoint (b);
7533 }
7534
7535 void
7536 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7537 {
7538 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7539 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7540 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7541 delete_breakpoint (b);
7542 }
7543
7544 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7545
7546 void
7547 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7548 {
7549 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7550 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7551 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7552 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7553 }
7554
7555 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7556 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7557 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7558
7559 static struct breakpoint *
7560 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7561 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7562 {
7563 struct breakpoint *b;
7564
7565 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7566 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7567 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7568 return b;
7569 }
7570
7571 struct breakpoint *
7572 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7573 {
7574 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7575 }
7576
7577 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7578
7579 struct breakpoint *
7580 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7581 {
7582 struct breakpoint *b;
7583
7584 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7585 locations. */
7586 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7587 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7588 {
7589 delete_breakpoint (b);
7590 return NULL;
7591 }
7592 return b;
7593 }
7594
7595 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7596 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7597
7598 void
7599 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7600 {
7601 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
7602 {
7603 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7604 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7605
7606 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7607 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7608 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7609 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7610 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7611 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7612 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7613 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7614 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7615 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7616 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7617 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7618 )
7619 {
7620 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7621 }
7622 }
7623 }
7624
7625 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7626 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7627 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7628
7629 static void
7630 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7631 {
7632 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7633
7634 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
7635 {
7636 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7637 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7638
7639 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7640 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7641 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7642 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7643 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7644 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7645 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7646 || is_tracepoint (b))
7647 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7648 {
7649 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7650 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7651 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7652 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7653 loc->inserted = 0;
7654
7655 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7656 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7657
7658 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7659 {
7660 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7661 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7662 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7663 solib->so_name);
7664 }
7665 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7666 }
7667 }
7668 }
7669
7670 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7671 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7672 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7673
7674 static void
7675 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7676 {
7677 if (objfile == NULL)
7678 return;
7679
7680 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7681 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7682 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7683 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7684 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7685 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7686 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7687 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7688 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7689 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7690 main objfile). */
7691 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7692 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7693 return;
7694
7695 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7696 {
7697 int bp_modified = 0;
7698
7699 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7700 continue;
7701
7702 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
7703 {
7704 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7705
7706 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7707 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7708 continue;
7709
7710 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7711 continue;
7712
7713 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7714 continue;
7715
7716 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7717 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7718 continue;
7719
7720 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7721 {
7722 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7723 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7724 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7725 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7726 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7727 unmapped. */
7728
7729 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7730
7731 bp_modified = 1;
7732 }
7733 }
7734
7735 if (bp_modified)
7736 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7737 }
7738 }
7739
7740 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7741
7742 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7743 catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
7744 to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7745
7746 struct fork_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7747 {
7748 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7749 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7750 catchpoint has triggered. */
7751 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7752 };
7753
7754 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7755 catchpoints. */
7756
7757 static int
7758 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7759 {
7760 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7761 }
7762
7763 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7764 catchpoints. */
7765
7766 static int
7767 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7768 {
7769 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7770 }
7771
7772 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7773 catchpoints. */
7774
7775 static int
7776 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7777 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7778 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7779 {
7780 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7781
7782 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7783 return 0;
7784
7785 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7786 return 1;
7787 }
7788
7789 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7790 catchpoints. */
7791
7792 static enum print_stop_action
7793 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7794 {
7795 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7796 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7797 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7798
7799 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7800 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7801 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7802 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7803 else
7804 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7805 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7806 {
7807 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7808 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7809 }
7810 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
7811 uiout->text (" (forked process ");
7812 uiout->field_signed ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7813 uiout->text ("), ");
7814 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7815 }
7816
7817 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7818 catchpoints. */
7819
7820 static void
7821 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7822 {
7823 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7824 struct value_print_options opts;
7825 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7826
7827 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7828
7829 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7830 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7831 readable). */
7832 if (opts.addressprint)
7833 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7834 annotate_field (5);
7835 uiout->text ("fork");
7836 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7837 {
7838 uiout->text (", process ");
7839 uiout->field_signed ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7840 uiout->spaces (1);
7841 }
7842
7843 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7844 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
7845 }
7846
7847 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7848 catchpoints. */
7849
7850 static void
7851 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7852 {
7853 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7854 }
7855
7856 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7857 catchpoints. */
7858
7859 static void
7860 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7861 {
7862 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7863 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7864 }
7865
7866 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7867
7868 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7869
7870 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7871 catchpoints. */
7872
7873 static int
7874 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7875 {
7876 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7877 }
7878
7879 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7880 catchpoints. */
7881
7882 static int
7883 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7884 {
7885 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7886 }
7887
7888 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7889 catchpoints. */
7890
7891 static int
7892 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7893 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7894 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7895 {
7896 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7897
7898 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7899 return 0;
7900
7901 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7902 return 1;
7903 }
7904
7905 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7906 catchpoints. */
7907
7908 static enum print_stop_action
7909 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7910 {
7911 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7912 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7913 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7914
7915 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7916 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7917 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7918 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7919 else
7920 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7921 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7922 {
7923 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7924 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7925 }
7926 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
7927 uiout->text (" (vforked process ");
7928 uiout->field_signed ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7929 uiout->text ("), ");
7930 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7931 }
7932
7933 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7934 catchpoints. */
7935
7936 static void
7937 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7938 {
7939 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7940 struct value_print_options opts;
7941 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7942
7943 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7944 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7945 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7946 readable). */
7947 if (opts.addressprint)
7948 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7949 annotate_field (5);
7950 uiout->text ("vfork");
7951 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7952 {
7953 uiout->text (", process ");
7954 uiout->field_signed ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7955 uiout->spaces (1);
7956 }
7957
7958 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7959 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
7960 }
7961
7962 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7963 catchpoints. */
7964
7965 static void
7966 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
7967 {
7968 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
7969 }
7970
7971 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7972 catchpoints. */
7973
7974 static void
7975 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7976 {
7977 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
7978 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7979 }
7980
7981 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
7982
7983 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
7984
7985 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7986 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7987 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7988
7989 struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7990 {
7991 ~solib_catchpoint () override;
7992
7993 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7994 bool is_load;
7995
7996 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7997 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7998 char *regex;
7999 std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
8000 };
8001
8002 solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
8003 {
8004 xfree (this->regex);
8005 }
8006
8007 static int
8008 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8009 {
8010 return 0;
8011 }
8012
8013 static int
8014 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8015 {
8016 return 0;
8017 }
8018
8019 static int
8020 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
8021 const address_space *aspace,
8022 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8023 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8024 {
8025 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8026
8027 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
8028 return 1;
8029
8030 for (breakpoint *other : all_breakpoints ())
8031 {
8032 if (other == bl->owner)
8033 continue;
8034
8035 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
8036 continue;
8037
8038 if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
8039 continue;
8040
8041 for (bp_location *other_bl : other->locations ())
8042 {
8043 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
8044 return 1;
8045 }
8046 }
8047
8048 return 0;
8049 }
8050
8051 static void
8052 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
8053 {
8054 struct solib_catchpoint *self
8055 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8056
8057 if (self->is_load)
8058 {
8059 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
8060 {
8061 if (!self->regex
8062 || self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8063 return;
8064 }
8065 }
8066 else
8067 {
8068 for (const std::string &iter : current_program_space->deleted_solibs)
8069 {
8070 if (!self->regex
8071 || self->compiled->exec (iter.c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8072 return;
8073 }
8074 }
8075
8076 bs->stop = 0;
8077 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8078 }
8079
8080 static enum print_stop_action
8081 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8082 {
8083 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8084 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8085
8086 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8087 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8088 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8089 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8090 else
8091 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8092 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
8093 uiout->text ("\n");
8094 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8095 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8096 print_solib_event (1);
8097 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8098 }
8099
8100 static void
8101 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8102 {
8103 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8104 struct value_print_options opts;
8105 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8106
8107 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8108 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8109 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8110 readable). */
8111 if (opts.addressprint)
8112 {
8113 annotate_field (4);
8114 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8115 }
8116
8117 std::string msg;
8118 annotate_field (5);
8119 if (self->is_load)
8120 {
8121 if (self->regex)
8122 msg = string_printf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8123 else
8124 msg = _("load of library");
8125 }
8126 else
8127 {
8128 if (self->regex)
8129 msg = string_printf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8130 else
8131 msg = _("unload of library");
8132 }
8133 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
8134
8135 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8136 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8137 }
8138
8139 static void
8140 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8141 {
8142 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8143
8144 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8145 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8146 }
8147
8148 static void
8149 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8150 {
8151 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8152
8153 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8154 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8155 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8156 if (self->regex)
8157 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8158 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8159 }
8160
8161 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8162
8163 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8164
8165 void
8166 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, bool is_load, bool is_temp, bool enabled)
8167 {
8168 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8169
8170 if (!arg)
8171 arg = "";
8172 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8173
8174 std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
8175
8176 if (*arg != '\0')
8177 {
8178 c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
8179 _("Invalid regexp")));
8180 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8181 }
8182
8183 c->is_load = is_load;
8184 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8185 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8186
8187 c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8188
8189 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8190 }
8191
8192 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8193 "catch unload". */
8194
8195 static void
8196 catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8197 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8198 {
8199 const int enabled = 1;
8200 bool temp = command->context () == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8201
8202 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, temp, enabled);
8203 }
8204
8205 static void
8206 catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8207 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8208 {
8209 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8210 }
8211
8212 static void
8213 catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8214 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8215 {
8216 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8217 }
8218
8219 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8220
8221 void
8222 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8223 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, bool temp,
8224 const char *cond_string,
8225 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8226 {
8227 symtab_and_line sal;
8228 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8229
8230 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8231
8232 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8233 b->disposition = temp ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8234 }
8235
8236 void
8237 install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
8238 {
8239 breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
8240 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8241 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8242 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8243 if (!internal)
8244 mention (b);
8245 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
8246
8247 if (update_gll)
8248 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8249 }
8250
8251 static void
8252 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8253 bool temp, const char *cond_string,
8254 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8255 {
8256 std::unique_ptr<fork_catchpoint> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
8257
8258 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, temp, cond_string, ops);
8259
8260 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8261
8262 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8263 }
8264
8265 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8266
8267 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8268 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8269 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8270
8271 struct exec_catchpoint : public breakpoint
8272 {
8273 ~exec_catchpoint () override;
8274
8275 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8276 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8277 triggered. */
8278 char *exec_pathname;
8279 };
8280
8281 /* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
8282
8283 exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
8284 {
8285 xfree (this->exec_pathname);
8286 }
8287
8288 static int
8289 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8290 {
8291 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8292 }
8293
8294 static int
8295 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8296 {
8297 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8298 }
8299
8300 static int
8301 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8302 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8303 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8304 {
8305 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8306
8307 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8308 return 0;
8309
8310 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8311 return 1;
8312 }
8313
8314 static enum print_stop_action
8315 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8316 {
8317 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8318 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8319 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8320
8321 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8322 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8323 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8324 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8325 else
8326 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8327 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8328 {
8329 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8330 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8331 }
8332 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
8333 uiout->text (" (exec'd ");
8334 uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8335 uiout->text ("), ");
8336
8337 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8338 }
8339
8340 static void
8341 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8342 {
8343 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8344 struct value_print_options opts;
8345 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8346
8347 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8348
8349 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8350 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8351 is relatively readable). */
8352 if (opts.addressprint)
8353 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8354 annotate_field (5);
8355 uiout->text ("exec");
8356 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8357 {
8358 uiout->text (", program \"");
8359 uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname);
8360 uiout->text ("\" ");
8361 }
8362
8363 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8364 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
8365 }
8366
8367 static void
8368 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8369 {
8370 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8371 }
8372
8373 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8374 catchpoints. */
8375
8376 static void
8377 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8378 {
8379 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8380 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8381 }
8382
8383 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8384
8385 static int
8386 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8387 {
8388 int i = 0;
8389
8390 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8391 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8392 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
8393 {
8394 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8395 one register. */
8396 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8397 }
8398
8399 return i;
8400 }
8401
8402 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8403 watchpoint. */
8404
8405 static int
8406 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8407 {
8408 int i = 0;
8409
8410 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8411 return 0;
8412
8413 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
8414 {
8415 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8416 one register. */
8417 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8418 }
8419
8420 return i;
8421 }
8422
8423 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8424 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8425 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8426 types _not_ TYPE. */
8427
8428 static int
8429 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8430 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8431 {
8432 int i = 0;
8433
8434 *other_type_used = 0;
8435 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8436 {
8437 if (b == except)
8438 continue;
8439 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8440 continue;
8441
8442 if (b->type == type)
8443 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8444 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8445 *other_type_used = 1;
8446 }
8447
8448 return i;
8449 }
8450
8451 void
8452 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8453 {
8454 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8455 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8456 {
8457 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8458 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8459 }
8460 }
8461
8462 void
8463 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8464 {
8465 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8466 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8467 {
8468 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8469 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8470 }
8471 }
8472
8473 void
8474 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8475 {
8476 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8477 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8478 }
8479
8480 void
8481 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8482 {
8483 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8484 breakpoint_re_set ();
8485 }
8486
8487 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8488 locations. */
8489
8490 static struct breakpoint *
8491 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8492 {
8493 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
8494
8495 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8496 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8497
8498 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8499 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8500
8501 b->thread = thread;
8502 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8503
8504 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
8505 }
8506
8507 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8508 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8509 frame. */
8510
8511 breakpoint_up
8512 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8513 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8514 {
8515 struct breakpoint *b;
8516
8517 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8518 tail-called one. */
8519 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8520
8521 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8522 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8523 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8524 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8525
8526 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
8527
8528 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8529
8530 return breakpoint_up (b);
8531 }
8532
8533 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8534 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8535 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8536
8537 static struct breakpoint *
8538 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8539 enum bptype type,
8540 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8541 int loc_enabled)
8542 {
8543 struct breakpoint *copy;
8544
8545 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8546 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8547 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
8548
8549 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8550 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8551 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8552 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8553 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8554 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8555 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8556 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8557 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8558 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8559 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8560 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8561
8562 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8563 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8564 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8565
8566 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8567 return copy;
8568 }
8569
8570 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8571 ORIG is NULL. */
8572
8573 struct breakpoint *
8574 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8575 {
8576 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8577 if (orig == NULL)
8578 return NULL;
8579
8580 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8581 }
8582
8583 breakpoint_up
8584 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8585 enum bptype type)
8586 {
8587 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8588
8589 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8590 sal.pc = pc;
8591 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8592 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8593
8594 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8595 }
8596 \f
8597
8598 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8599
8600 static void
8601 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8602 {
8603 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8604 current_uiout->text ("\n");
8605 }
8606 \f
8607
8608 static bool bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8609
8610 /* Handle "set breakpoint auto-hw on".
8611
8612 If the explicitly specified breakpoint type is not hardware
8613 breakpoint, check the memory map to see whether the breakpoint
8614 address is in read-only memory.
8615
8616 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory is read-only.
8617 We change the type of the location to hardware breakpoint.
8618
8619 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write. This
8620 means we've previously made the location hardware one, but then the
8621 memory map changed, so we undo.
8622 */
8623
8624 static void
8625 handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (bp_location *bl)
8626 {
8627 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints
8628 && bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
8629 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
8630 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint))
8631 {
8632 /* When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
8633 location types we've just set here, the only possible problem
8634 is that memory map has changed during running program, but
8635 it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
8636 mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address);
8637
8638 if (mr != nullptr)
8639 {
8640 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
8641
8642 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
8643 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
8644 else
8645 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
8646
8647 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
8648 {
8649 static bool said = false;
8650
8651 bl->loc_type = new_type;
8652 if (!said)
8653 {
8654 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
8655 _("Note: automatically using "
8656 "hardware breakpoints for "
8657 "read-only addresses.\n"));
8658 said = true;
8659 }
8660 }
8661 }
8662 }
8663 }
8664
8665 static struct bp_location *
8666 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8667 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8668 {
8669 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8670 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8671 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8672
8673 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8674 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8675
8676 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8677 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8678 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8679 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8680 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8681 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8682 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8683 sal->pc, b->type);
8684
8685 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8686 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8687 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8688 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8689 ;
8690 loc->next = *tmp;
8691 *tmp = loc;
8692
8693 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8694 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8695 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8696 loc->probe.prob = sal->prob;
8697 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8698 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8699 loc->section = sal->section;
8700 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8701 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8702 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8703 loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
8704 loc->msymbol = sal->msymbol;
8705 loc->objfile = sal->objfile;
8706
8707 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
8708
8709 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8710 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8711 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8712 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8713 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8714 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8715 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8716 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8717 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8718 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8719 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8720 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8721 instruction.) */
8722 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8723 loc->permanent = 1;
8724
8725 return loc;
8726 }
8727 \f
8728
8729 /* Return true if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8730 return false otherwise. */
8731
8732 static bool
8733 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8734 {
8735 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8736
8737 /* If we have a non-breakpoint-backed catchpoint or a software
8738 watchpoint, just return 0. We should not attempt to read from
8739 the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types point to.
8740 gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8741 memory. */
8742 if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (loc))
8743 return false;
8744
8745 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
8746 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8747 return gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
8748 }
8749
8750 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8751 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8752
8753 static void
8754 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8755 {
8756 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
8757 char *printf_line = NULL;
8758
8759 if (!dprintf_args)
8760 return;
8761
8762 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8763
8764 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8765 insist on it. */
8766 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8767 ++dprintf_args;
8768 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8769
8770 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8771 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8772
8773 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
8774 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8775 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
8776 {
8777 if (!dprintf_function)
8778 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8779
8780 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
8781 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8782 dprintf_function,
8783 dprintf_channel,
8784 dprintf_args);
8785 else
8786 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8787 dprintf_function,
8788 dprintf_args);
8789 }
8790 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
8791 {
8792 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8793 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
8794 else
8795 {
8796 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8797 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8798 }
8799 }
8800 else
8801 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8802 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8803
8804 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
8805
8806 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8807 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
8808 = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line);
8809 breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line,
8810 command_lines_deleter ()));
8811 }
8812
8813 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8814 current style settings. */
8815
8816 static void
8817 update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty,
8818 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8819 {
8820 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8821 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8822 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8823 }
8824
8825 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8826 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8827 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8828 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8829
8830 static void
8831 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8832 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8833 event_location_up &&location,
8834 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8835 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8836 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8837 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8838 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8839 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8840 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8841 int display_canonical)
8842 {
8843 int i;
8844
8845 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8846 {
8847 int target_resources_ok;
8848
8849 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8850 target_resources_ok =
8851 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8852 i + 1, 0);
8853 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8854 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8855 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8856 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8857 }
8858
8859 gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
8860
8861 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8862 {
8863 struct bp_location *loc;
8864
8865 if (from_tty)
8866 {
8867 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8868 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8869 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8870
8871 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8872 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8873 }
8874
8875 if (&sal == &sals[0])
8876 {
8877 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8878 b->thread = thread;
8879 b->task = task;
8880
8881 b->cond_string = cond_string.release ();
8882 b->extra_string = extra_string.release ();
8883 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8884 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8885 b->disposition = disposition;
8886
8887 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8888 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8889
8890 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8891 {
8892 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8893 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8894
8895 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8896 {
8897 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8898 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8899 const char *p
8900 = &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
8901 const char *endp;
8902
8903 p = skip_spaces (p);
8904
8905 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8906
8907 t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p);
8908
8909 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8910 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8911 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8912 }
8913 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8914 {
8915 t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
8916
8917 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8918 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8919 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8920 }
8921 else
8922 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8923 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8924 }
8925
8926 loc = b->loc;
8927 }
8928 else
8929 {
8930 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8931 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8932 loc->inserted = 1;
8933 }
8934
8935 /* Do not set breakpoint locations conditions yet. As locations
8936 are inserted, they get sorted based on their addresses. Let
8937 the list stabilize to have reliable location numbers. */
8938
8939 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8940 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8941 if (type == bp_dprintf)
8942 {
8943 if (b->extra_string)
8944 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8945 else
8946 error (_("Format string required"));
8947 }
8948 else if (b->extra_string)
8949 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
8950 }
8951
8952
8953 /* The order of the locations is now stable. Set the location
8954 condition using the location's number. */
8955 int loc_num = 1;
8956 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
8957 {
8958 if (b->cond_string != nullptr)
8959 set_breakpoint_location_condition (b->cond_string, loc, b->number,
8960 loc_num);
8961
8962 ++loc_num;
8963 }
8964
8965 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
8966 if (location != NULL)
8967 b->location = std::move (location);
8968 else
8969 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
8970 b->filter = std::move (filter);
8971 }
8972
8973 static void
8974 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8975 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8976 event_location_up &&location,
8977 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8978 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8979 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8980 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8981 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8982 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8983 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8984 int display_canonical)
8985 {
8986 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
8987
8988 init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
8989 sals, std::move (location),
8990 std::move (filter),
8991 std::move (cond_string),
8992 std::move (extra_string),
8993 type, disposition,
8994 thread, task, ignore_count,
8995 ops, from_tty,
8996 enabled, internal, flags,
8997 display_canonical);
8998
8999 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9000 }
9001
9002 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
9003 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
9004 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
9005 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
9006 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
9007 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
9008 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
9009 we take just a single condition string.
9010
9011 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
9012 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
9013 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
9014 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
9015 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
9016
9017 static void
9018 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9019 struct linespec_result *canonical,
9020 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
9021 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
9022 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9023 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9024 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9025 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
9026 {
9027 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
9028 gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
9029
9030 for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
9031 {
9032 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
9033 'break', without arguments. */
9034 event_location_up location
9035 = (canonical->location != NULL
9036 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
9037 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
9038 (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
9039
9040 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
9041 std::move (location),
9042 std::move (filter_string),
9043 std::move (cond_string),
9044 std::move (extra_string),
9045 type, disposition,
9046 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9047 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
9048 canonical->special_display);
9049 }
9050 }
9051
9052 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
9053 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
9054 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
9055 linespec locations).
9056
9057 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
9058 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
9059
9060 static void
9061 parse_breakpoint_sals (struct event_location *location,
9062 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9063 {
9064 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
9065
9066 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9067 {
9068 const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9069
9070 if (spec == NULL)
9071 {
9072 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
9073 breakpoint address. */
9074 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9075 {
9076 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9077 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9078 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9079 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9080 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9081 symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
9082 CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
9083
9084 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9085
9086 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9087 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9088 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9089 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9090 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9091 sal.pc = pc;
9092 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9093
9094 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9095 lsal.sals = {sal};
9096 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9097
9098 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
9099 return;
9100 }
9101 else
9102 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9103 }
9104 }
9105
9106 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9107 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9108 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9109 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9110
9111 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9112 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9113 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9114 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9115 {
9116 const char *spec = NULL;
9117
9118 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9119 spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9120
9121 if (!cursal.symtab
9122 || (spec != NULL
9123 && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL
9124 && spec[1] != '['))
9125 {
9126 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9127 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9128 get_last_displayed_line (),
9129 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9130 return;
9131 }
9132 }
9133
9134 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9135 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9136 }
9137
9138
9139 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9140 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9141
9142 static void
9143 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
9144 {
9145 for (auto &sal : sals)
9146 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
9147 }
9148
9149 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9150 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9151 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9152 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9153 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9154 it, etc. */
9155
9156 static void
9157 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9158 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
9159 {
9160 for (const auto &sal : sals)
9161 {
9162 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9163
9164 sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9165 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9166 associated with SAL. */
9167 if (sarch == NULL)
9168 sarch = gdbarch;
9169 std::string msg;
9170 if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg))
9171 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9172 paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ());
9173 }
9174 }
9175
9176 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9177 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9178 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9179 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9180 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9181 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9182
9183 static void
9184 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9185 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9186 char **rest)
9187 {
9188 *cond_string = NULL;
9189 *thread = -1;
9190 *task = 0;
9191 *rest = NULL;
9192 bool force = false;
9193
9194 while (tok && *tok)
9195 {
9196 const char *end_tok;
9197 int toklen;
9198 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9199 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9200
9201 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
9202
9203 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9204 {
9205 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9206 return;
9207 }
9208
9209 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
9210
9211 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9212
9213 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9214 {
9215 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9216 try
9217 {
9218 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9219 }
9220 catch (const gdb_exception_error &)
9221 {
9222 if (!force)
9223 throw;
9224 else
9225 tok = tok + strlen (tok);
9226 }
9227 cond_end = tok;
9228 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9229 }
9230 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "-force-condition", toklen) == 0)
9231 {
9232 tok = tok + toklen;
9233 force = true;
9234 }
9235 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9236 {
9237 const char *tmptok;
9238 struct thread_info *thr;
9239
9240 tok = end_tok + 1;
9241 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9242 if (tok == tmptok)
9243 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9244 *thread = thr->global_num;
9245 tok = tmptok;
9246 }
9247 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9248 {
9249 char *tmptok;
9250
9251 tok = end_tok + 1;
9252 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9253 if (tok == tmptok)
9254 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9255 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9256 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9257 tok = tmptok;
9258 }
9259 else if (rest)
9260 {
9261 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9262 return;
9263 }
9264 else
9265 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9266 }
9267 }
9268
9269 /* Call 'find_condition_and_thread' for each sal in SALS until a parse
9270 succeeds. The parsed values are written to COND_STRING, THREAD,
9271 TASK, and REST. See the comment of 'find_condition_and_thread'
9272 for the description of these parameters and INPUT. */
9273
9274 static void
9275 find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (const std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals,
9276 const char *input, char **cond_string,
9277 int *thread, int *task, char **rest)
9278 {
9279 int num_failures = 0;
9280 for (auto &sal : sals)
9281 {
9282 char *cond = nullptr;
9283 int thread_id = 0;
9284 int task_id = 0;
9285 char *remaining = nullptr;
9286
9287 /* Here we want to parse 'arg' to separate condition from thread
9288 number. But because parsing happens in a context and the
9289 contexts of sals might be different, try each until there is
9290 success. Finding one successful parse is sufficient for our
9291 goal. When setting the breakpoint we'll re-parse the
9292 condition in the context of each sal. */
9293 try
9294 {
9295 find_condition_and_thread (input, sal.pc, &cond, &thread_id,
9296 &task_id, &remaining);
9297 *cond_string = cond;
9298 *thread = thread_id;
9299 *task = task_id;
9300 *rest = remaining;
9301 break;
9302 }
9303 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
9304 {
9305 num_failures++;
9306 /* If no sal remains, do not continue. */
9307 if (num_failures == sals.size ())
9308 throw;
9309 }
9310 }
9311 }
9312
9313 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9314
9315 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
9316 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9317 {
9318 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9319 const char *endp;
9320
9321 p = skip_spaces (p);
9322
9323 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9324
9325 std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
9326
9327 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
9328 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
9329 if (markers.empty ())
9330 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
9331 marker_str.c_str ());
9332
9333 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
9334 sals.reserve (markers.size ());
9335
9336 for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers)
9337 {
9338 symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0);
9339 sal.pc = marker.address;
9340 sals.push_back (sal);
9341 }
9342
9343 *arg_p = endp;
9344 return sals;
9345 }
9346
9347 /* Returns the breakpoint ops appropriate for use with with LOCATION_TYPE and
9348 according to IS_TRACEPOINT. */
9349
9350 static const struct breakpoint_ops *
9351 breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type (enum event_location_type location_type,
9352 bool is_tracepoint)
9353 {
9354 if (is_tracepoint)
9355 {
9356 if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION)
9357 return &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9358 else
9359 return &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
9360 }
9361 else
9362 {
9363 if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION)
9364 return &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9365 else
9366 return &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9367 }
9368 }
9369
9370 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9371
9372 const struct breakpoint_ops *
9373 breakpoint_ops_for_event_location (const struct event_location *location,
9374 bool is_tracepoint)
9375 {
9376 if (location != nullptr)
9377 return breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type
9378 (event_location_type (location), is_tracepoint);
9379 return is_tracepoint ? &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops : &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9380 }
9381
9382 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9383
9384 int
9385 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9386 struct event_location *location,
9387 const char *cond_string,
9388 int thread, const char *extra_string,
9389 bool force_condition, int parse_extra,
9390 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9391 int ignore_count,
9392 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9393 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9394 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9395 unsigned flags)
9396 {
9397 struct linespec_result canonical;
9398 int pending = 0;
9399 int task = 0;
9400 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9401
9402 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9403
9404 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9405 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9406 extra_string = NULL;
9407
9408 try
9409 {
9410 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9411 }
9412 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
9413 {
9414 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9415 value. */
9416 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9417 {
9418 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9419 error. */
9420
9421 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9422 throw;
9423
9424 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9425
9426 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9427 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9428 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9429 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9430 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9431 return 0;
9432
9433 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9434 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9435 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9436 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9437 pending = 1;
9438 }
9439 else
9440 throw;
9441 }
9442
9443 if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
9444 return 0;
9445
9446 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9447 are ok for the target. */
9448 if (!pending)
9449 {
9450 for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9451 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
9452 }
9453
9454 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9455 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9456 {
9457 for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9458 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
9459 }
9460
9461 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9462 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9463 breakpoint. */
9464 if (!pending)
9465 {
9466 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
9467 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
9468
9469 if (parse_extra)
9470 {
9471 char *rest;
9472 char *cond;
9473
9474 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9475
9476 find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (lsal.sals, extra_string,
9477 &cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
9478 cond_string_copy.reset (cond);
9479 extra_string_copy.reset (rest);
9480 }
9481 else
9482 {
9483 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9484 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9485 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9486
9487 /* Check the validity of the condition. We should error out
9488 if the condition is invalid at all of the locations and
9489 if it is not forced. In the PARSE_EXTRA case above, this
9490 check is done when parsing the EXTRA_STRING. */
9491 if (cond_string != nullptr && !force_condition)
9492 {
9493 int num_failures = 0;
9494 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9495 for (const auto &sal : lsal.sals)
9496 {
9497 const char *cond = cond_string;
9498 try
9499 {
9500 parse_exp_1 (&cond, sal.pc, block_for_pc (sal.pc), 0);
9501 /* One success is sufficient to keep going. */
9502 break;
9503 }
9504 catch (const gdb_exception_error &)
9505 {
9506 num_failures++;
9507 /* If this is the last sal, error out. */
9508 if (num_failures == lsal.sals.size ())
9509 throw;
9510 }
9511 }
9512 }
9513
9514 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9515 if (cond_string)
9516 cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
9517 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9518 if (extra_string)
9519 extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
9520 }
9521
9522 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9523 std::move (cond_string_copy),
9524 std::move (extra_string_copy),
9525 type_wanted,
9526 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9527 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9528 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9529 }
9530 else
9531 {
9532 std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
9533
9534 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9535 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9536
9537 if (parse_extra)
9538 b->cond_string = NULL;
9539 else
9540 {
9541 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9542 b->cond_string = cond_string != NULL ? xstrdup (cond_string) : NULL;
9543 b->thread = thread;
9544 }
9545
9546 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9547 b->extra_string = extra_string != NULL ? xstrdup (extra_string) : NULL;
9548 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9549 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9550 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9551 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9552 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9553 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9554 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9555
9556 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9557 }
9558
9559 if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
9560 {
9561 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9562 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9563 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9564 }
9565
9566 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9567
9568 return 1;
9569 }
9570
9571 /* Set a breakpoint.
9572 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9573 condition, and thread.
9574 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9575 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9576 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9577
9578 static void
9579 break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9580 {
9581 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9582 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9583 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9584 : bp_breakpoint);
9585
9586 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9587 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
9588 (location.get (), false /* is_tracepoint */);
9589
9590 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9591 location.get (),
9592 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
9593 tempflag, type_wanted,
9594 0 /* Ignore count */,
9595 pending_break_support,
9596 ops,
9597 from_tty,
9598 1 /* enabled */,
9599 0 /* internal */,
9600 0);
9601 }
9602
9603 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9604
9605 void
9606 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9607 {
9608 CORE_ADDR pc;
9609
9610 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9611 {
9612 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9613 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9614 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9615 sal->pc = pc;
9616
9617 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9618 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9619 if (sal->explicit_line)
9620 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9621 }
9622
9623 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9624 {
9625 const struct blockvector *bv;
9626 const struct block *b;
9627 struct symbol *sym;
9628
9629 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9630 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9631 if (bv != NULL)
9632 {
9633 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9634 if (sym != NULL)
9635 {
9636 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9637 sal->section = sym->obj_section (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9638 }
9639 else
9640 {
9641 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9642 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9643 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9644 happen in assembly source). */
9645
9646 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
9647 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9648
9649 bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9650 if (msym.minsym)
9651 sal->section = msym.obj_section ();
9652 }
9653 }
9654 }
9655 }
9656
9657 void
9658 break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9659 {
9660 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9661 }
9662
9663 void
9664 tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9665 {
9666 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9667 }
9668
9669 static void
9670 hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9671 {
9672 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9673 }
9674
9675 static void
9676 thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9677 {
9678 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9679 }
9680
9681 static void
9682 stop_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9683 {
9684 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9685 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9686 stop at <line>\n"));
9687 }
9688
9689 static void
9690 stopin_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9691 {
9692 int badInput = 0;
9693
9694 if (arg == NULL)
9695 badInput = 1;
9696 else if (*arg != '*')
9697 {
9698 const char *argptr = arg;
9699 int hasColon = 0;
9700
9701 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9702 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9703 function/method name. */
9704 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9705 {
9706 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9707 argptr++;
9708 }
9709
9710 if (hasColon)
9711 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9712 else
9713 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
9714 }
9715
9716 if (badInput)
9717 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9718 else
9719 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9720 }
9721
9722 static void
9723 stopat_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9724 {
9725 int badInput = 0;
9726
9727 if (arg == NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
9728 badInput = 1;
9729 else
9730 {
9731 const char *argptr = arg;
9732 int hasColon = 0;
9733
9734 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9735 it is probably a line number. */
9736 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9737 {
9738 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9739 argptr++;
9740 }
9741
9742 if (hasColon)
9743 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
9744 else
9745 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
9746 }
9747
9748 if (badInput)
9749 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at LINE\n"));
9750 else
9751 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9752 }
9753
9754 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9755 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9756 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9757 line. */
9758
9759 static void
9760 dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9761 {
9762 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9763
9764 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9765 the next character must be ','. */
9766 if (arg != NULL)
9767 {
9768 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
9769 error (_("Format string required"));
9770 else
9771 {
9772 /* Skip the comma. */
9773 ++arg;
9774 }
9775 }
9776
9777 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9778 location.get (),
9779 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
9780 0, bp_dprintf,
9781 0 /* Ignore count */,
9782 pending_break_support,
9783 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9784 from_tty,
9785 1 /* enabled */,
9786 0 /* internal */,
9787 0);
9788 }
9789
9790 static void
9791 agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9792 {
9793 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9794 }
9795
9796 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9797 ranged breakpoints. */
9798
9799 static int
9800 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9801 const address_space *aspace,
9802 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9803 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
9804 {
9805 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9806 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9807 return 0;
9808
9809 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9810 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9811 }
9812
9813 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9814 ranged breakpoints. */
9815
9816 static int
9817 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9818 {
9819 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9820 }
9821
9822 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9823 ranged breakpoints. */
9824
9825 static enum print_stop_action
9826 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
9827 {
9828 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9829 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9830 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9831
9832 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9833
9834 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9835 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9836
9837 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9838
9839 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9840
9841 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9842 uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9843 else
9844 uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9845 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9846 {
9847 uiout->field_string ("reason",
9848 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9849 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9850 }
9851 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
9852 uiout->text (", ");
9853
9854 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9855 }
9856
9857 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9858 ranged breakpoints. */
9859
9860 static void
9861 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9862 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9863 {
9864 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9865 struct value_print_options opts;
9866 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9867
9868 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9869 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9870
9871 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9872
9873 if (opts.addressprint)
9874 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9875 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9876 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
9877 annotate_field (5);
9878 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9879 *last_loc = bl;
9880 }
9881
9882 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9883 ranged breakpoints. */
9884
9885 static void
9886 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9887 struct ui_out *uiout)
9888 {
9889 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9890 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9891 string_file stb;
9892
9893 gdb_assert (bl);
9894
9895 address_start = bl->address;
9896 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9897
9898 uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
9899 stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9900 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9901 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9902 uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
9903 uiout->text ("\n");
9904 }
9905
9906 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9907 ranged breakpoints. */
9908
9909 static void
9910 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9911 {
9912 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9913 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9914
9915 gdb_assert (bl);
9916 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9917
9918 uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9919 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9920 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9921 }
9922
9923 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9924 ranged breakpoints. */
9925
9926 static void
9927 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9928 {
9929 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
9930 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
9931 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
9932 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9933 }
9934
9935 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9936
9937 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9938
9939 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9940 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9941 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9942 last instruction of the given line. */
9943
9944 static CORE_ADDR
9945 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9946 {
9947 CORE_ADDR end;
9948
9949 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9950 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9951 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9952 end = sal.pc;
9953 else
9954 {
9955 int ret;
9956 CORE_ADDR start;
9957
9958 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9959 if (!ret)
9960 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9961
9962 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9963 end--;
9964 }
9965
9966 return end;
9967 }
9968
9969 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9970
9971 static void
9972 break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9973 {
9974 const char *arg_start;
9975 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9976 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9977 CORE_ADDR end;
9978 struct breakpoint *b;
9979
9980 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9981 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9982 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9983
9984 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9985 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9986 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9987 bp_count, 0);
9988 if (can_use_bp < 0)
9989 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9990
9991 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9992 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9993 error(_("No address range specified."));
9994
9995 arg_start = arg;
9996 event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9997 current_language);
9998 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
9999
10000 if (arg[0] != ',')
10001 error (_("Too few arguments."));
10002 else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
10003 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
10004
10005 const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
10006
10007 if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
10008 || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
10009 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10010
10011 const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
10012 std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
10013
10014 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
10015 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10016
10017 /* Parse the end location. */
10018
10019 arg_start = arg;
10020
10021 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
10022 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
10023 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
10024 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
10025 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
10026 event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
10027 current_language);
10028 decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
10029 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
10030 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
10031
10032 if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
10033 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10034
10035 const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
10036 if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
10037 || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
10038 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10039
10040 const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
10041
10042 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
10043 if (sal_start.pc > end)
10044 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
10045
10046 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
10047 if (length < 0)
10048 /* Length overflowed. */
10049 error (_("Address range too large."));
10050 else if (length == 1)
10051 {
10052 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
10053 the `hbreak' command. */
10054 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
10055
10056 return;
10057 }
10058
10059 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
10060 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
10061 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
10062 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
10063 b->number = breakpoint_count;
10064 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10065 b->location = std::move (start_location);
10066 b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
10067 b->loc->length = length;
10068
10069 mention (b);
10070 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
10071 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
10072 }
10073
10074 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
10075 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
10076 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
10077 zero. */
10078
10079 static bool
10080 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
10081 {
10082 return exp->op->constant_p ();
10083 }
10084
10085 /* Watchpoint destructor. */
10086
10087 watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
10088 {
10089 xfree (this->exp_string);
10090 xfree (this->exp_string_reparse);
10091 }
10092
10093 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10094
10095 static void
10096 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10097 {
10098 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10099
10100 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10101 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10102
10103 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10104 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10105 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10106 are loaded and unloaded.
10107
10108 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10109 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10110 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10111 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10112 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10113 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10114
10115 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10116 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10117 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10118 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10119
10120 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10121 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10122
10123 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10124 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10125 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10126 }
10127
10128 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10129
10130 static int
10131 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10132 {
10133 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10134 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10135
10136 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10137 w->cond_exp.get ());
10138 }
10139
10140 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10141
10142 static int
10143 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10144 {
10145 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10146 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10147
10148 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10149 w->cond_exp.get ());
10150 }
10151
10152 static int
10153 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10154 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10155 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10156 {
10157 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10158 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10159
10160 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10161 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10162 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10163 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10164 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10165 (did not match the data address). */
10166 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10167 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10168 return 0;
10169
10170 return 1;
10171 }
10172
10173 static void
10174 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10175 {
10176 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10177
10178 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10179 }
10180
10181 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10182 hardware watchpoints. */
10183
10184 static int
10185 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10186 {
10187 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10188 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10189
10190 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10191 }
10192
10193 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10194 hardware watchpoints. */
10195
10196 static int
10197 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10198 {
10199 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10200 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10201 }
10202
10203 static enum print_stop_action
10204 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10205 {
10206 struct breakpoint *b;
10207 enum print_stop_action result;
10208 struct watchpoint *w;
10209 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10210
10211 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10212
10213 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10214 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10215
10216 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10217 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10218
10219 string_file stb;
10220
10221 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
10222 switch (b->type)
10223 {
10224 case bp_watchpoint:
10225 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10226 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10227 uiout->field_string
10228 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10229 mention (b);
10230 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10231 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10232 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10233 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10234 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10235 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10236 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10237 uiout->text ("\n");
10238 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10239 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10240 break;
10241
10242 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10243 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10244 uiout->field_string
10245 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10246 mention (b);
10247 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10248 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10249 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10250 uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
10251 uiout->text ("\n");
10252 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10253 break;
10254
10255 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10256 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10257 {
10258 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10259 uiout->field_string
10260 ("reason",
10261 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10262 mention (b);
10263 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10264 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10265 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10266 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10267 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10268 }
10269 else
10270 {
10271 mention (b);
10272 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10273 uiout->field_string
10274 ("reason",
10275 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10276 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10277 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10278 }
10279 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10280 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10281 uiout->text ("\n");
10282 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10283 break;
10284 default:
10285 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10286 }
10287
10288 return result;
10289 }
10290
10291 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10292 watchpoints. */
10293
10294 static void
10295 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10296 {
10297 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10298 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10299 const char *tuple_name;
10300
10301 switch (b->type)
10302 {
10303 case bp_watchpoint:
10304 uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
10305 tuple_name = "wpt";
10306 break;
10307 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10308 uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
10309 tuple_name = "wpt";
10310 break;
10311 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10312 uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
10313 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10314 break;
10315 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10316 uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10317 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10318 break;
10319 default:
10320 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10321 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10322 }
10323
10324 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10325 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
10326 uiout->text (": ");
10327 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10328 }
10329
10330 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10331 watchpoints. */
10332
10333 static void
10334 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10335 {
10336 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10337
10338 switch (b->type)
10339 {
10340 case bp_watchpoint:
10341 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10342 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10343 break;
10344 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10345 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10346 break;
10347 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10348 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10349 break;
10350 default:
10351 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10352 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10353 }
10354
10355 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10356 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10357 }
10358
10359 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10360 watchpoints. */
10361
10362 static int
10363 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10364 {
10365 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10366 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10367 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10368 return 0;
10369
10370 return 1;
10371 }
10372
10373 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10374
10375 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10376
10377 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10378 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10379
10380 static int
10381 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10382 {
10383 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10384
10385 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10386 bl->watchpoint_type);
10387 }
10388
10389 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10390 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10391
10392 static int
10393 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10394 {
10395 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10396
10397 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10398 bl->watchpoint_type);
10399 }
10400
10401 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10402 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10403
10404 static int
10405 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10406 {
10407 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10408
10409 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10410 }
10411
10412 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10413 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10414
10415 static int
10416 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10417 {
10418 return 0;
10419 }
10420
10421 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10422 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10423
10424 static enum print_stop_action
10425 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10426 {
10427 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10428 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10429
10430 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10431 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10432
10433 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10434 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10435
10436 switch (b->type)
10437 {
10438 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10439 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10440 uiout->field_string
10441 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10442 break;
10443
10444 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10445 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10446 uiout->field_string
10447 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10448 break;
10449
10450 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10451 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10452 uiout->field_string
10453 ("reason",
10454 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10455 break;
10456 default:
10457 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10458 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10459 }
10460
10461 mention (b);
10462 uiout->text (_("\n\
10463 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10464 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10465 uiout->text ("\n");
10466
10467 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10468 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10469 }
10470
10471 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10472 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10473
10474 static void
10475 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10476 struct ui_out *uiout)
10477 {
10478 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10479
10480 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10481 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10482
10483 uiout->text ("\tmask ");
10484 uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10485 uiout->text ("\n");
10486 }
10487
10488 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10489 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10490
10491 static void
10492 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10493 {
10494 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10495 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10496 const char *tuple_name;
10497
10498 switch (b->type)
10499 {
10500 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10501 uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10502 tuple_name = "wpt";
10503 break;
10504 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10505 uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10506 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10507 break;
10508 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10509 uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10510 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10511 break;
10512 default:
10513 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10514 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10515 }
10516
10517 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10518 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
10519 uiout->text (": ");
10520 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10521 }
10522
10523 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10524 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10525
10526 static void
10527 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10528 {
10529 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10530
10531 switch (b->type)
10532 {
10533 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10534 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10535 break;
10536 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10537 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10538 break;
10539 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10540 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10541 break;
10542 default:
10543 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10544 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10545 }
10546
10547 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string,
10548 phex (w->hw_wp_mask, sizeof (CORE_ADDR)));
10549 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10550 }
10551
10552 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10553
10554 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10555
10556 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10557
10558 static bool
10559 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10560 {
10561 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10562 }
10563
10564 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10565 hw_read: watch read,
10566 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10567 static void
10568 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10569 bool just_location, bool internal)
10570 {
10571 struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10572 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10573 struct value *result;
10574 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
10575 const char *exp_start = NULL;
10576 const char *exp_end = NULL;
10577 const char *tok, *end_tok;
10578 int toklen = -1;
10579 const char *cond_start = NULL;
10580 const char *cond_end = NULL;
10581 enum bptype bp_type;
10582 int thread = -1;
10583 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10584 the hardware watchpoint. */
10585 bool use_mask = false;
10586 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10587
10588 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10589 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10590 {
10591 const char *value_start;
10592
10593 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
10594
10595 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10596 of the arguments string. */
10597 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10598 {
10599 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10600 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10601 tok--;
10602
10603 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10604 This is the value of the parameter. */
10605 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10606 tok--;
10607 value_start = tok + 1;
10608
10609 /* Skip whitespace. */
10610 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10611 tok--;
10612
10613 end_tok = tok;
10614
10615 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10616 This is the parameter itself. */
10617 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10618 tok--;
10619 tok++;
10620 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10621
10622 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
10623 {
10624 struct thread_info *thr;
10625 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10626 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10627 only in a specific thread. */
10628 const char *endp;
10629
10630 if (thread != -1)
10631 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10632
10633 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10634 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
10635
10636 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10637 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10638 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
10639
10640 thread = thr->global_num;
10641 }
10642 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
10643 {
10644 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10645 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10646 facility. */
10647 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10648
10649 if (use_mask)
10650 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10651
10652 use_mask = just_location = true;
10653
10654 mark = value_mark ();
10655 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10656 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10657 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10658 }
10659 else
10660 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10661 break;
10662
10663 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10664 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10665 exp_end = tok;
10666 }
10667 }
10668 else
10669 exp_end = arg;
10670
10671 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10672 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10673 ARG. */
10674 std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
10675 exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
10676 innermost_block_tracker tracker;
10677 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
10678 exp_end = arg;
10679 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10680 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10681 prettier. */
10682 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10683 --exp_end;
10684
10685 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10686 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
10687 {
10688 int len;
10689
10690 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10691 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10692 len--;
10693 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10694 }
10695
10696 exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
10697 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
10698 struct value *val_as_value = nullptr;
10699 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), exp->op.get (), &val_as_value, &result, NULL,
10700 just_location);
10701
10702 if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location)
10703 {
10704 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val_as_value);
10705 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val_as_value);
10706 }
10707
10708 value_ref_ptr val;
10709 if (just_location)
10710 {
10711 int ret;
10712
10713 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10714 val = release_value (value_addr (result));
10715 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10716
10717 if (use_mask)
10718 {
10719 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()),
10720 mask);
10721 if (ret == -1)
10722 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10723 else if (ret == -2)
10724 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10725 }
10726 }
10727 else if (val_as_value != NULL)
10728 val = release_value (val_as_value);
10729
10730 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10731 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10732
10733 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10734 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10735 {
10736 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10737 innermost_block_tracker if_tracker;
10738 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0, &if_tracker);
10739
10740 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10741 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10742 cond_exp_valid_block = if_tracker.block ();
10743
10744 cond_end = tok;
10745 }
10746 if (*tok)
10747 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10748
10749 frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10750
10751 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10752 'wp_frame'. */
10753 frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
10754
10755 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10756 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10757 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10758 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10759 if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
10760 {
10761 frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
10762
10763 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10764 {
10765 gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
10766 CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
10767
10768 scope_breakpoint
10769 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
10770 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10771 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10772
10773 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10774 wp_frame = NULL;
10775
10776 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10777
10778 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10779 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10780
10781 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10782 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
10783
10784 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10785 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
10786 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
10787 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10788 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10789 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10790 scope_breakpoint->type);
10791 }
10792 }
10793
10794 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10795 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10796 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10797 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10798
10799 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10800 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10801 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10802 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10803 else
10804 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10805
10806 std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
10807
10808 if (use_mask)
10809 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10810 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10811 else
10812 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10813 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10814 w->thread = thread;
10815 w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10816 w->pspace = current_program_space;
10817 w->exp = std::move (exp);
10818 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10819 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10820 if (just_location)
10821 {
10822 struct type *t = value_type (val.get ());
10823 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ());
10824
10825 w->exp_string_reparse
10826 = current_language->watch_location_expression (t, addr).release ();
10827
10828 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10829 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10830 }
10831 else
10832 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
10833
10834 if (use_mask)
10835 {
10836 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10837 }
10838 else
10839 {
10840 w->val = val;
10841 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
10842 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
10843 w->val_valid = true;
10844 }
10845
10846 if (cond_start)
10847 w->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
10848 else
10849 w->cond_string = 0;
10850
10851 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
10852 {
10853 w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
10854 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10855 }
10856 else
10857 {
10858 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10859 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10860 }
10861
10862 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10863 {
10864 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10865 need to act on them together. */
10866 w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10867 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
10868 }
10869
10870 if (!just_location)
10871 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10872
10873 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10874 that should be inserted. */
10875 update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
10876
10877 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
10878 }
10879
10880 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10881 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10882
10883 static int
10884 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals)
10885 {
10886 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10887
10888 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10889 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10890 return 0;
10891
10892 gdb_assert (!vals.empty ());
10893 struct value *head = vals[0].get ();
10894
10895 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10896 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10897 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10898 hardware watchpoint.
10899
10900 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10901 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10902 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10903 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10904 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10905 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10906 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10907 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10908 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10909
10910 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10911 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10912 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10913 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10914 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals)
10915 {
10916 struct value *v = iter.get ();
10917
10918 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
10919 {
10920 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
10921 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10922 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10923 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10924 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10925 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10926 ;
10927 else
10928 {
10929 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10930 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10931 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
10932
10933 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10934 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10935 middle of some value chain. */
10936 if (v == head
10937 || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10938 && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
10939 {
10940 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
10941 int len;
10942 int num_regs;
10943
10944 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
10945 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
10946 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
10947
10948 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
10949 if (!num_regs)
10950 return 0;
10951 else
10952 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
10953 }
10954 }
10955 }
10956 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
10957 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
10958 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10959 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
10960 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10961 }
10962
10963 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10964 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10965 return found_memory_cnt;
10966 }
10967
10968 void
10969 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal)
10970 {
10971 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
10972 }
10973
10974 /* Options for the watch, awatch, and rwatch commands. */
10975
10976 struct watch_options
10977 {
10978 /* For -location. */
10979 bool location = false;
10980 };
10981
10982 /* Definitions of options for the "watch", "awatch", and "rwatch" commands.
10983
10984 Historically GDB always accepted both '-location' and '-l' flags for
10985 these commands (both flags being synonyms). When converting to the
10986 newer option scheme only '-location' is added here. That's fine (for
10987 backward compatibility) as any non-ambiguous prefix of a flag will be
10988 accepted, so '-l', '-loc', are now all accepted.
10989
10990 What this means is that, if in the future, we add any new flag here
10991 that starts with '-l' then this will break backward compatibility, so
10992 please, don't do that! */
10993
10994 static const gdb::option::option_def watch_option_defs[] = {
10995 gdb::option::flag_option_def<watch_options> {
10996 "location",
10997 [] (watch_options *opt) { return &opt->location; },
10998 N_("\
10999 This evaluates EXPRESSION and watches the memory to which is refers.\n\
11000 -l can be used as a short form of -location."),
11001 },
11002 };
11003
11004 /* Returns the option group used by 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch'
11005 commands. */
11006
11007 static gdb::option::option_def_group
11008 make_watch_options_def_group (watch_options *opts)
11009 {
11010 return {{watch_option_defs}, opts};
11011 }
11012
11013 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
11014 calls watch_command_1. */
11015
11016 static void
11017 watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
11018 {
11019 watch_options opts;
11020 auto grp = make_watch_options_def_group (&opts);
11021 gdb::option::process_options
11022 (&arg, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, grp);
11023 if (arg != nullptr && *arg == '\0')
11024 arg = nullptr;
11025
11026 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, opts.location, false);
11027 }
11028
11029 /* Command completion for 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch' commands. */
11030 static void
11031 watch_command_completer (struct cmd_list_element *ignore,
11032 completion_tracker &tracker,
11033 const char *text, const char * /*word*/)
11034 {
11035 const auto group = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr);
11036 if (gdb::option::complete_options
11037 (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, group))
11038 return;
11039
11040 const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text);
11041 expression_completer (ignore, tracker, text, word);
11042 }
11043
11044 static void
11045 watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11046 {
11047 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
11048 }
11049
11050 void
11051 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal)
11052 {
11053 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
11054 }
11055
11056 static void
11057 rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11058 {
11059 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
11060 }
11061
11062 void
11063 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal)
11064 {
11065 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
11066 }
11067
11068 static void
11069 awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11070 {
11071 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
11072 }
11073 \f
11074
11075 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
11076 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
11077 breakpoints. */
11078
11079 struct until_break_fsm : public thread_fsm
11080 {
11081 /* The thread that was current when the command was executed. */
11082 int thread;
11083
11084 /* The breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame,
11085 plus breakpoints at all the destination locations. */
11086 std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints;
11087
11088 until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
11089 std::vector<breakpoint_up> &&breakpoints)
11090 : thread_fsm (cmd_interp),
11091 thread (thread),
11092 breakpoints (std::move (breakpoints))
11093 {
11094 }
11095
11096 void clean_up (struct thread_info *thread) override;
11097 bool should_stop (struct thread_info *thread) override;
11098 enum async_reply_reason do_async_reply_reason () override;
11099 };
11100
11101 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
11102 until(location)/advance commands. */
11103
11104 bool
11105 until_break_fsm::should_stop (struct thread_info *tp)
11106 {
11107 for (const breakpoint_up &bp : breakpoints)
11108 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11109 bp.get ()) != NULL)
11110 {
11111 set_finished ();
11112 break;
11113 }
11114
11115 return true;
11116 }
11117
11118 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
11119 until(location)/advance commands. */
11120
11121 void
11122 until_break_fsm::clean_up (struct thread_info *)
11123 {
11124 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
11125 breakpoints.clear ();
11126 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (thread);
11127 }
11128
11129 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11130 until(location)/advance commands. */
11131
11132 enum async_reply_reason
11133 until_break_fsm::do_async_reply_reason ()
11134 {
11135 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11136 }
11137
11138 void
11139 until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11140 {
11141 struct frame_info *frame;
11142 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11143 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11144 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11145 int thread;
11146 struct thread_info *tp;
11147
11148 clear_proceed_status (0);
11149
11150 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11151 this function. */
11152
11153 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11154
11155 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
11156 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
11157 ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
11158 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11159 get_last_displayed_line ())
11160 : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11161 NULL, NULL, 0));
11162
11163 if (sals.empty ())
11164 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11165
11166 if (*arg)
11167 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11168
11169 tp = inferior_thread ();
11170 thread = tp->global_num;
11171
11172 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11173 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11174 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11175 that. */
11176
11177 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11178 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11179 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11180 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11181
11182 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11183 one. */
11184
11185 std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints;
11186
11187 gdb::optional<delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup> lj_deleter;
11188
11189 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11190 {
11191 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11192 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11193
11194 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11195 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11196 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11197
11198 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint
11199 = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch, sal2,
11200 caller_frame_id, bp_until);
11201 breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (caller_breakpoint));
11202
11203 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11204 lj_deleter.emplace (thread);
11205 }
11206
11207 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11208 frame = NULL;
11209
11210 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location, we
11211 don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. Otherwise,
11212 specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only at the
11213 very same frame. */
11214 frame_id stop_frame_id = anywhere ? null_frame_id : stack_frame_id;
11215
11216 for (symtab_and_line &sal : sals)
11217 {
11218 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11219
11220 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint
11221 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11222 stop_frame_id, bp_until);
11223 breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (location_breakpoint));
11224 }
11225
11226 tp->thread_fsm = new until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11227 std::move (breakpoints));
11228
11229 if (lj_deleter)
11230 lj_deleter->release ();
11231
11232 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11233 }
11234
11235 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11236 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11237
11238 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11239 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11240 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11241 if clause in the arg string. */
11242
11243 const char *
11244 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg)
11245 {
11246 const char *cond_string;
11247
11248 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11249 return NULL;
11250
11251 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11252 (*arg) += 2;
11253
11254 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11255 condition string. */
11256 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11257 cond_string = *arg;
11258
11259 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11260 string. */
11261 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11262
11263 return cond_string;
11264 }
11265
11266 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11267 process start/exit, etc. */
11268
11269 typedef enum
11270 {
11271 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11272 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11273 }
11274 catch_fork_kind;
11275
11276 static void
11277 catch_fork_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11278 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11279 {
11280 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11281 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11282 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11283
11284 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) command->context ();
11285 bool temp = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11286 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11287
11288 if (!arg)
11289 arg = "";
11290 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11291
11292 /* The allowed syntax is:
11293 catch [v]fork
11294 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11295
11296 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11297 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11298
11299 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11300 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11301
11302 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11303 and enable reporting of such events. */
11304 switch (fork_kind)
11305 {
11306 case catch_fork_temporary:
11307 case catch_fork_permanent:
11308 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, temp, cond_string,
11309 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11310 break;
11311 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11312 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11313 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, temp, cond_string,
11314 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11315 break;
11316 default:
11317 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11318 break;
11319 }
11320 }
11321
11322 static void
11323 catch_exec_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11324 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11325 {
11326 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11327 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11328 bool temp = command->context () == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11329
11330 if (!arg)
11331 arg = "";
11332 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11333
11334 /* The allowed syntax is:
11335 catch exec
11336 catch exec if <cond>
11337
11338 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11339 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11340
11341 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11342 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11343
11344 std::unique_ptr<exec_catchpoint> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
11345 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, temp, cond_string,
11346 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11347 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11348
11349 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
11350 }
11351
11352 void
11353 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11354 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11355 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11356 const char *addr_string,
11357 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11358 int tempflag,
11359 int enabled,
11360 int from_tty)
11361 {
11362 if (from_tty)
11363 {
11364 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11365 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11366 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11367
11368 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11369 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11370 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11371 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11372 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11373 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11374 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11375 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11376 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11377 enough for now, though. */
11378 }
11379
11380 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
11381
11382 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11383 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11384 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11385 language_def (language_ada));
11386 b->language = language_ada;
11387 }
11388
11389 \f
11390
11391 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
11392
11393 static int
11394 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11395 {
11396 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
11397 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
11398
11399 if (a->number < b->number)
11400 return -1;
11401 else if (a->number > b->number)
11402 return 1;
11403
11404 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11405 the number 0. */
11406 if (ua < ub)
11407 return -1;
11408 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11409 }
11410
11411 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11412
11413 static void
11414 clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11415 {
11416 int default_match;
11417
11418 std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
11419 symtab_and_line last_sal;
11420 gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
11421 if (arg)
11422 {
11423 decoded_sals
11424 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11425 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11426 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11427 default_match = 0;
11428 sals = decoded_sals;
11429 }
11430 else
11431 {
11432 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11433 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11434 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11435 last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
11436 if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
11437 error (_("No source file specified."));
11438
11439 default_match = 1;
11440 sals = last_sal;
11441 }
11442
11443 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11444 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11445 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11446 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11447
11448 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11449 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11450 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11451 due to optimization, all in one block.
11452
11453 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11454 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11455 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11456 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11457 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11458 to support that. */
11459
11460 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11461 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11462 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11463 breakpoint. */
11464
11465 std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
11466 for (const auto &sal : sals)
11467 {
11468 const char *sal_fullname;
11469
11470 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11471 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11472 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11473 or at default pc.
11474
11475 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11476
11477 0 1 pc
11478 1 1 pc _and_ line
11479 0 0 line
11480 1 0 <can't happen> */
11481
11482 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11483 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11484
11485 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11486 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
11487 {
11488 int match = 0;
11489 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11490 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11491 {
11492 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
11493 {
11494 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11495 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11496 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11497 && sal.pc
11498 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11499 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11500 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11501 || loc->section == sal.section));
11502 int line_match = 0;
11503
11504 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11505 && loc->symtab != NULL
11506 && sal_fullname != NULL
11507 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11508 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11509 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11510 sal_fullname) == 0)
11511 line_match = 1;
11512
11513 if (pc_match || line_match)
11514 {
11515 match = 1;
11516 break;
11517 }
11518 }
11519 }
11520
11521 if (match)
11522 found.push_back (b);
11523 }
11524 }
11525
11526 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11527 if (found.empty ())
11528 {
11529 if (arg)
11530 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11531 else
11532 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11533 }
11534
11535 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11536 std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
11537 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11538 {
11539 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0;
11540 });
11541 found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
11542 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11543 {
11544 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0;
11545 }),
11546 found.end ());
11547
11548 if (found.size () > 1)
11549 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11550 if (from_tty)
11551 {
11552 if (found.size () == 1)
11553 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11554 else
11555 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11556 }
11557
11558 for (breakpoint *iter : found)
11559 {
11560 if (from_tty)
11561 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter->number);
11562 delete_breakpoint (iter);
11563 }
11564 if (from_tty)
11565 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11566 }
11567 \f
11568 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11569 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11570 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11571
11572 void
11573 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11574 {
11575 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11576 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11577 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11578 && bs->stop)
11579 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11580
11581 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
11582 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11583 delete_breakpoint (b);
11584 }
11585
11586 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11587 std::sort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11588 bl_address_is_meaningful says), secondarily by ordering first
11589 permanent elements and terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted
11590 stable way despite std::sort being an unstable algorithm. */
11591
11592 static int
11593 bp_location_is_less_than (const bp_location *a, const bp_location *b)
11594 {
11595 if (a->address != b->address)
11596 return a->address < b->address;
11597
11598 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11599 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11600 grouped. */
11601
11602 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11603 return a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num;
11604
11605 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11606 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
11607 return a->permanent > b->permanent;
11608
11609 /* Sort by type in order to make duplicate determination easier.
11610 See update_global_location_list. This is kept in sync with
11611 breakpoint_locations_match. */
11612 if (a->loc_type < b->loc_type)
11613 return true;
11614
11615 /* Likewise, for range-breakpoints, sort by length. */
11616 if (a->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
11617 && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
11618 && a->length < b->length)
11619 return true;
11620
11621 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11622 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11623 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11624
11625 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11626 return a->owner->number < b->owner->number;
11627
11628 return a < b;
11629 }
11630
11631 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11632 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11633 content of the bp_locations array. */
11634
11635 static void
11636 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11637 {
11638 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11639 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11640
11641 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
11642 {
11643 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11644
11645 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11646 continue;
11647
11648 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11649 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11650
11651 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11652 addr = bl->address - start;
11653 if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
11654 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11655
11656 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11657
11658 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11659 addr = end - bl->address;
11660 if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11661 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11662 }
11663 }
11664
11665 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11666
11667 static void
11668 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11669 {
11670 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
11671
11672 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
11673
11674 for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ())
11675 {
11676 struct tracepoint *t;
11677 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
11678
11679 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11680 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11681 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11682 continue;
11683
11684 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
11685 {
11686 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11687 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
11688 else
11689 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
11690 }
11691
11692 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
11693 break;
11694
11695 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
11696 {
11697 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11698 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11699 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11700 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11701 continue;
11702
11703 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11704
11705 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11706
11707 bl->inserted = 1;
11708 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
11709 }
11710 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
11711 t->number_on_target = b->number;
11712 if (bp_location_downloaded)
11713 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
11714 }
11715 }
11716
11717 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11718
11719 static void
11720 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11721 {
11722 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11723 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11724 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11725 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11726
11727 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11728 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11729 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11730 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11731 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11732
11733 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11734 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11735 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11736 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11737 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11738 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11739 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11740 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11741 }
11742
11743 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11744 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11745 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11746 the target. */
11747
11748 static void
11749 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11750 {
11751 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11752 int pspace_num;
11753
11754 address = bl->address;
11755 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11756
11757 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11758 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11759 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11760 side. */
11761 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11762 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11763 return;
11764
11765 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11766 the same program space as the location
11767 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11768 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11769 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations_at_addr (address))
11770 {
11771 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11772 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11773 continue;
11774
11775 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11776 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11777 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11778 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11779 that have already been marked. */
11780 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11781
11782 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11783 it later on. */
11784 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
11785 }
11786 }
11787
11788 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11789 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11790 locations are duplicate of which.
11791
11792 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11793 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11794 info. */
11795
11796 static void
11797 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11798 {
11799 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11800 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11801 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11802 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11803
11804 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11805 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11806 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11807 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11808 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11809 once. */
11810 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11811 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11812 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11813 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11814
11815 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11816 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11817 std::vector<bp_location *> old_locations = std::move (bp_locations);
11818 bp_locations.clear ();
11819
11820 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
11821 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
11822 bp_locations.push_back (loc);
11823
11824 /* See if we need to "upgrade" a software breakpoint to a hardware
11825 breakpoint. Do this before deciding whether locations are
11826 duplicates. Also do this before sorting because sorting order
11827 depends on location type. */
11828 for (bp_location *loc : bp_locations)
11829 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
11830 handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (loc);
11831
11832 std::sort (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (),
11833 bp_location_is_less_than);
11834
11835 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11836
11837 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11838 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11839 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11840 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11841 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11842 location.
11843
11844 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11845 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11846
11847 size_t loc_i = 0;
11848 for (bp_location *old_loc : old_locations)
11849 {
11850 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11851 not, we have to free it. */
11852 int found_object = 0;
11853 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11854 int keep_in_target = 0;
11855 int removed = 0;
11856
11857 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11858 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11859 while (loc_i < bp_locations.size ()
11860 && bp_locations[loc_i]->address < old_loc->address)
11861 loc_i++;
11862
11863 for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i;
11864 (loc2_i < bp_locations.size ()
11865 && bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address);
11866 loc2_i++)
11867 {
11868 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11869 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11870 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11871 place there. */
11872 if (bp_locations[loc2_i]->condition_changed == condition_modified
11873 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
11874 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
11875 {
11876 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (bp_locations[loc2_i]);
11877 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
11878 }
11879
11880 if (bp_locations[loc2_i] == old_loc)
11881 found_object = 1;
11882 }
11883
11884 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11885 have to go through updates again. */
11886 last_addr = old_loc->address;
11887
11888 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11889 if (!found_object)
11890 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
11891
11892 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
11893 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
11894 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
11895 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
11896 at certain location is not inserted. */
11897
11898 if (old_loc->inserted)
11899 {
11900 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
11901 it. */
11902
11903 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
11904 {
11905 /* The location is still present in the location list,
11906 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
11907 keep_in_target = 1;
11908 }
11909 else
11910 {
11911 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
11912 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
11913 remove its target-side condition. */
11914
11915 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
11916 disabled. See if there's another location at the
11917 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
11918 this one from the target. */
11919
11920 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
11921 if (bl_address_is_meaningful (old_loc))
11922 {
11923 for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i;
11924 (loc2_i < bp_locations.size ()
11925 && bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address);
11926 loc2_i++)
11927 {
11928 bp_location *loc2 = bp_locations[loc2_i];
11929
11930 if (loc2 == old_loc)
11931 continue;
11932
11933 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
11934 {
11935 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
11936 access watchpoints, if the former are not
11937 supported, but the latter are. */
11938 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
11939 {
11940 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
11941 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
11942 }
11943
11944 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
11945 if it should be inserted in case it will be
11946 unduplicated. */
11947 if (unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
11948 {
11949 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
11950 keep_in_target = 1;
11951 break;
11952 }
11953 }
11954 }
11955 }
11956 }
11957
11958 if (!keep_in_target)
11959 {
11960 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
11961 {
11962 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
11963 this location on the global list, and try to
11964 remove it next time, but there's no particular
11965 reason why we will succeed next time.
11966
11967 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
11968 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
11969 only after calling us. */
11970 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
11971 "breakpoint %d\n"),
11972 old_loc->owner->number);
11973 }
11974 removed = 1;
11975 }
11976 }
11977
11978 if (!found_object)
11979 {
11980 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
11981 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
11982 {
11983 /* This location was removed from the target. In
11984 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
11985 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
11986 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
11987 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
11988 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
11989 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
11990 after we see some number of events. The theory here
11991 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
11992 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
11993 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
11994 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
11995 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
11996 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
11997 SIGTRAP.
11998
11999 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
12000 decr_pc_after_break targets.
12001
12002 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
12003 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
12004 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
12005 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
12006 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
12007 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
12008 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
12009 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
12010 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
12011 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
12012 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
12013 targets that do not support new thread events, like
12014 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
12015 thread_count.
12016
12017 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12018 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12019 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12020 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12021
12022 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12023 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12024 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12025 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12026 traps we can no longer explain. */
12027
12028 process_stratum_target *proc_target = nullptr;
12029 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
12030 if (inf->pspace == old_loc->pspace)
12031 {
12032 proc_target = inf->process_target ();
12033 break;
12034 }
12035 if (proc_target != nullptr)
12036 old_loc->events_till_retirement
12037 = 3 * (thread_count (proc_target) + 1);
12038 else
12039 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 1;
12040 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12041
12042 moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc);
12043 }
12044 else
12045 {
12046 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12047 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12048 }
12049 }
12050 }
12051
12052 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12053 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12054 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12055 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12056 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12057 are sorted first for the same address.
12058
12059 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12060 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12061
12062 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12063 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12064 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12065 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12066
12067 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
12068 {
12069 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12070 non-NULL. */
12071 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12072 breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
12073
12074 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12075 || !bl_address_is_meaningful (loc)
12076 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12077 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12078 `struct bp_location'. */
12079 || is_tracepoint (b))
12080 {
12081 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12082 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12083 continue;
12084 }
12085
12086 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12087 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12088 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12089 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12090 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12091 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12092 else
12093 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12094
12095 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12096 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12097 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12098 {
12099 *loc_first_p = loc;
12100 loc->duplicate = 0;
12101
12102 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12103 {
12104 loc->needs_update = 1;
12105 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12106 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12107 }
12108 continue;
12109 }
12110
12111
12112 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12113 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12114 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12115 if (loc->inserted)
12116 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12117 loc->duplicate = 1;
12118
12119 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12120 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12121 }
12122
12123 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12124 {
12125 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12126 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12127 else
12128 {
12129 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12130 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12131 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12132 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12133 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12134 "needs_update". */
12135 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12136 }
12137 }
12138
12139 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12140 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12141 }
12142
12143 void
12144 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12145 {
12146 for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix)
12147 {
12148 struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix];
12149 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12150 {
12151 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12152 unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix);
12153 --ix;
12154 }
12155 }
12156 }
12157
12158 static void
12159 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12160 {
12161
12162 try
12163 {
12164 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12165 }
12166 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12167 {
12168 }
12169 }
12170
12171 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12172
12173 static void
12174 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12175 {
12176 bpstat bs;
12177
12178 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12179 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12180 {
12181 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12182 bs->old_val = NULL;
12183 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12184 }
12185 }
12186
12187 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12188 static int
12189 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12190 {
12191 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12192
12193 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12194 return 0;
12195 }
12196
12197 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12198 callbacks. */
12199
12200 static void
12201 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12202 {
12203 struct value_print_options opts;
12204
12205 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12206
12207 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12208 single string. */
12209 if (b->loc == NULL)
12210 {
12211 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12212 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12213 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12214 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12215 {
12216 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12217 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12218 }
12219 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12220 {
12221 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12222 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12223 b->extra_string);
12224 }
12225 else
12226 {
12227 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12228 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12229 b->extra_string);
12230 }
12231 }
12232 else
12233 {
12234 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12235 printf_filtered (" at %ps",
12236 styled_string (address_style.style (),
12237 paddress (b->loc->gdbarch,
12238 b->loc->address)));
12239 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12240 {
12241 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12242 more nicely. */
12243 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12244 {
12245 const char *filename
12246 = symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab);
12247 printf_filtered (": file %ps, line %d.",
12248 styled_string (file_name_style.style (),
12249 filename),
12250 b->loc->line_number);
12251 }
12252 else
12253 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12254 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12255 real situation somewhat. */
12256 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12257 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12258 }
12259
12260 if (b->loc->next)
12261 {
12262 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12263 int n = 0;
12264 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12265 ++n;
12266 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12267 }
12268 }
12269 }
12270
12271 bp_location::~bp_location ()
12272 {
12273 xfree (function_name);
12274 }
12275
12276 /* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
12277
12278 breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
12279 {
12280 xfree (this->cond_string);
12281 xfree (this->extra_string);
12282 }
12283
12284 /* See breakpoint.h. */
12285
12286 bp_locations_range breakpoint::locations ()
12287 {
12288 return bp_locations_range (this->loc);
12289 }
12290
12291 static struct bp_location *
12292 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12293 {
12294 return new bp_location (self);
12295 }
12296
12297 static void
12298 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12299 {
12300 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12301 }
12302
12303 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12304 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12305
12306 static int
12307 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12308 {
12309 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12310 }
12311
12312 static int
12313 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12314 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12315 {
12316 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12317 }
12318
12319 static int
12320 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12321 const address_space *aspace,
12322 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12323 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12324 {
12325 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12326 }
12327
12328 static void
12329 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12330 {
12331 /* Always stop. */
12332 }
12333
12334 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12335 errors. */
12336
12337 static int
12338 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12339 {
12340 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12341 }
12342
12343 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12344 errors. */
12345
12346 static int
12347 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12348 {
12349 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12350 }
12351
12352 static enum print_stop_action
12353 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12354 {
12355 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12356 }
12357
12358 static void
12359 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12360 struct ui_out *uiout)
12361 {
12362 /* nothing */
12363 }
12364
12365 static void
12366 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12367 {
12368 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12369 }
12370
12371 static void
12372 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12373 {
12374 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12375 }
12376
12377 static void
12378 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12379 (struct event_location *location,
12380 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12381 enum bptype type_wanted)
12382 {
12383 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12384 }
12385
12386 static void
12387 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12388 struct linespec_result *c,
12389 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12390 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12391 enum bptype type_wanted,
12392 enum bpdisp disposition,
12393 int thread,
12394 int task, int ignore_count,
12395 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12396 int from_tty, int enabled,
12397 int internal, unsigned flags)
12398 {
12399 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12400 }
12401
12402 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12403 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12404 struct event_location *location,
12405 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12406 {
12407 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12408 }
12409
12410 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12411
12412 static int
12413 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12414 {
12415 return 1;
12416 }
12417
12418 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12419
12420 static void
12421 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12422 {
12423 /* Nothing to do. */
12424 }
12425
12426 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12427 {
12428 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12429 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12430 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12431 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12432 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12433 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12434 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12435 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12436 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12437 NULL,
12438 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12439 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12440 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12441 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12442 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12443 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12444 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12445 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12446 };
12447
12448 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12449
12450 static void
12451 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12452 {
12453 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12454 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
12455 {
12456 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12457 delete_breakpoint (b);
12458 return;
12459 }
12460
12461 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12462 }
12463
12464 static int
12465 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12466 {
12467 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
12468
12469 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
12470 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
12471
12472 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12473 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12474 else
12475 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12476 }
12477
12478 static int
12479 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12480 {
12481 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12482 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12483 else
12484 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
12485 }
12486
12487 static int
12488 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12489 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12490 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12491 {
12492 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12493 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12494 return 0;
12495
12496 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12497 aspace, bp_addr))
12498 return 0;
12499
12500 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12501 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12502 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12503 return 0;
12504
12505 return 1;
12506 }
12507
12508 static int
12509 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12510 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12511 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12512 {
12513 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
12514 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12515 {
12516 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12517 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12518 be set at the same address. */
12519 return 0;
12520 }
12521
12522 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
12523 }
12524
12525 static int
12526 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12527 {
12528 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12529
12530 return 1;
12531 }
12532
12533 static enum print_stop_action
12534 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12535 {
12536 struct breakpoint *b;
12537 const struct bp_location *bl;
12538 int bp_temp;
12539 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12540
12541 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12542
12543 bl = bs->bp_location_at.get ();
12544 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12545
12546 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12547 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12548 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12549 bl->address,
12550 b->number, 1);
12551 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12552 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
12553
12554 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12555 {
12556 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12557 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12558 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12559 }
12560 if (bp_temp)
12561 uiout->message ("Temporary breakpoint %pF, ",
12562 signed_field ("bkptno", b->number));
12563 else
12564 uiout->message ("Breakpoint %pF, ",
12565 signed_field ("bkptno", b->number));
12566
12567 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12568 }
12569
12570 static void
12571 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12572 {
12573 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12574 return;
12575
12576 switch (b->type)
12577 {
12578 case bp_breakpoint:
12579 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12580 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12581 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12582 else
12583 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12584 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12585 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12586 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12587 break;
12588 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12589 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12590 break;
12591 case bp_dprintf:
12592 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12593 break;
12594 }
12595
12596 say_where (b);
12597 }
12598
12599 static void
12600 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12601 {
12602 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12603 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
12604 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12605 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
12606 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12607 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12608 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
12609 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12610 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
12611 else
12612 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12613 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12614
12615 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12616 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
12617
12618 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12619 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12620 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
12621 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
12622
12623 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12624 }
12625
12626 static void
12627 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
12628 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12629 enum bptype type_wanted)
12630 {
12631 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12632 }
12633
12634 static void
12635 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12636 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12637 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12638 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12639 enum bptype type_wanted,
12640 enum bpdisp disposition,
12641 int thread,
12642 int task, int ignore_count,
12643 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12644 int from_tty, int enabled,
12645 int internal, unsigned flags)
12646 {
12647 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12648 std::move (cond_string),
12649 std::move (extra_string),
12650 type_wanted,
12651 disposition, thread, task,
12652 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12653 enabled, internal, flags);
12654 }
12655
12656 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12657 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12658 struct event_location *location,
12659 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12660 {
12661 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12662 }
12663
12664 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12665
12666 static void
12667 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12668 {
12669 switch (b->type)
12670 {
12671 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12672 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12673 case bp_overlay_event:
12674 case bp_longjmp_master:
12675 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12676 case bp_exception_master:
12677 delete_breakpoint (b);
12678 break;
12679
12680 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12681 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12682 case bp_shlib_event:
12683
12684 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12685 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12686 case bp_thread_event:
12687 break;
12688 }
12689 }
12690
12691 static void
12692 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12693 {
12694 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12695 {
12696 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12697 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12698 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12699 objects (among other things). */
12700 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12701 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12702 }
12703 else
12704 bs->stop = 0;
12705 }
12706
12707 static enum print_stop_action
12708 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12709 {
12710 struct breakpoint *b;
12711
12712 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12713
12714 switch (b->type)
12715 {
12716 case bp_shlib_event:
12717 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12718 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12719 to shlib event" message.) */
12720 print_solib_event (0);
12721 break;
12722
12723 case bp_thread_event:
12724 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12725 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12726 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12727 break;
12728
12729 case bp_overlay_event:
12730 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12731 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12732 break;
12733
12734 case bp_longjmp_master:
12735 /* These should never be enabled. */
12736 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12737 break;
12738
12739 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12740 /* These should never be enabled. */
12741 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12742 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12743 break;
12744
12745 case bp_exception_master:
12746 /* These should never be enabled. */
12747 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12748 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12749 break;
12750 }
12751
12752 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12753 }
12754
12755 static void
12756 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12757 {
12758 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12759 }
12760
12761 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12762
12763 static void
12764 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12765 {
12766 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12767 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12768 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12769 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12770 }
12771
12772 static void
12773 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12774 {
12775 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12776 }
12777
12778 static enum print_stop_action
12779 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12780 {
12781 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12782 }
12783
12784 static void
12785 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12786 {
12787 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12788 }
12789
12790 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12791
12792 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12793 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12794
12795 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12796 {
12797 thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
12798
12799 if (tp != NULL)
12800 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12801 }
12802
12803 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12804
12805 static int
12806 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12807 {
12808 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12809
12810 if (v == 0)
12811 {
12812 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12813 if needed. */
12814 bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12815 }
12816
12817 return v;
12818 }
12819
12820 static int
12821 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12822 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12823 {
12824 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12825 bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12826
12827 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
12828 }
12829
12830 static void
12831 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
12832 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12833 enum bptype type_wanted)
12834 {
12835 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12836
12837 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
12838 lsal.canonical
12839 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12840 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12841 }
12842
12843 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12844 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12845 struct event_location *location,
12846 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12847 {
12848 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
12849 if (sals.empty ())
12850 error (_("probe not found"));
12851 return sals;
12852 }
12853
12854 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12855
12856 static void
12857 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12858 {
12859 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12860 }
12861
12862 static int
12863 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12864 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12865 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12866 {
12867 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12868 tracepoints. */
12869 return 0;
12870 }
12871
12872 static void
12873 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12874 struct ui_out *uiout)
12875 {
12876 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12877 if (!tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
12878 {
12879 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
12880
12881 uiout->message ("\tmarker id is %pF\n",
12882 string_field ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12883 tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()));
12884 }
12885 }
12886
12887 static void
12888 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12889 {
12890 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12891 return;
12892
12893 switch (b->type)
12894 {
12895 case bp_tracepoint:
12896 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
12897 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12898 break;
12899 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
12900 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
12901 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12902 break;
12903 case bp_static_tracepoint:
12904 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
12905 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12906 break;
12907 default:
12908 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12909 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
12910 }
12911
12912 say_where (b);
12913 }
12914
12915 static void
12916 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
12917 {
12918 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12919
12920 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
12921 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
12922 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
12923 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
12924 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
12925 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
12926 else
12927 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12928 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
12929
12930 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12931 event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
12932 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
12933
12934 if (tp->pass_count)
12935 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
12936 }
12937
12938 static void
12939 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
12940 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12941 enum bptype type_wanted)
12942 {
12943 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12944 }
12945
12946 static void
12947 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12948 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12949 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12950 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12951 enum bptype type_wanted,
12952 enum bpdisp disposition,
12953 int thread,
12954 int task, int ignore_count,
12955 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12956 int from_tty, int enabled,
12957 int internal, unsigned flags)
12958 {
12959 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12960 std::move (cond_string),
12961 std::move (extra_string),
12962 type_wanted,
12963 disposition, thread, task,
12964 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12965 enabled, internal, flags);
12966 }
12967
12968 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12969 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12970 struct event_location *location,
12971 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12972 {
12973 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12974 }
12975
12976 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
12977
12978 /* Virtual table for tracepoints on static probes. */
12979
12980 static void
12981 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
12982 (struct event_location *location,
12983 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12984 enum bptype type_wanted)
12985 {
12986 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12987 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12988 }
12989
12990 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12991 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12992 struct event_location *location,
12993 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12994 {
12995 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12996 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
12997 }
12998
12999 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
13000
13001 static void
13002 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13003 {
13004 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13005
13006 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
13007 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
13008
13009 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
13010 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
13011 3 - disconnect from target 1
13012 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
13013
13014 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
13015 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
13016 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
13017 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
13018 it all the time. */
13019 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
13020 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
13021 }
13022
13023 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
13024
13025 static void
13026 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13027 {
13028 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
13029 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
13030 tp->extra_string);
13031 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13032 }
13033
13034 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
13035 dprintf.
13036
13037 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
13038 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
13039 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
13040 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13041 address are all handled. */
13042
13043 static void
13044 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13045 {
13046 struct bpstats tmp_bs;
13047 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13048
13049 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13050 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13051 condition not be evaluated. */
13052 bs->stop = 0;
13053
13054 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13055 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13056 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13057 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13058 commands here throws. */
13059 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13060 bs->commands = NULL;
13061
13062 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13063
13064 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13065 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13066 list. */
13067 }
13068
13069 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13070 markers (`-m'). */
13071
13072 static void
13073 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
13074 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13075 enum bptype type_wanted)
13076 {
13077 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13078 const char *arg_start, *arg;
13079
13080 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13081 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
13082
13083 std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
13084 const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
13085 canonical->location
13086 = new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
13087
13088 lsal.canonical
13089 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
13090 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
13091 }
13092
13093 static void
13094 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13095 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13096 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13097 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13098 enum bptype type_wanted,
13099 enum bpdisp disposition,
13100 int thread,
13101 int task, int ignore_count,
13102 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13103 int from_tty, int enabled,
13104 int internal, unsigned flags)
13105 {
13106 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
13107
13108 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13109 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13110 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13111 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13112 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13113 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13114
13115 for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
13116 {
13117 event_location_up location
13118 = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
13119
13120 std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
13121 init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
13122 std::move (location), NULL,
13123 std::move (cond_string),
13124 std::move (extra_string),
13125 type_wanted, disposition,
13126 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13127 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13128 canonical->special_display);
13129 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13130 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13131 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13132 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13133 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13134 corresponds to this one */
13135 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13136
13137 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
13138 }
13139 }
13140
13141 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13142 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13143 struct event_location *location,
13144 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13145 {
13146 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13147 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13148
13149 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13150 if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13151 {
13152 sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13153 sals.resize (1);
13154 return sals;
13155 }
13156 else
13157 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13158 }
13159
13160 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13161
13162 static int
13163 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13164 {
13165 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13166 }
13167
13168 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13169 structures. */
13170
13171 void
13172 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13173 {
13174 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13175
13176 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13177 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13178 especial culprits.
13179
13180 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13181 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13182 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13183 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13184 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13185 deleted.
13186
13187 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13188 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13189 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13190 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13191 was chosen. */
13192 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13193 return;
13194
13195 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13196 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13197 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13198 {
13199 struct breakpoint *related;
13200 struct watchpoint *w;
13201
13202 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13203 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13204 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13205 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13206 else
13207 w = NULL;
13208 if (w != NULL)
13209 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13210
13211 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13212 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13213 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13214 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13215 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13216 }
13217
13218 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13219 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13220 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13221 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13222 if (bpt->number)
13223 gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (bpt);
13224
13225 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13226 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13227
13228 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
13229 if (b->next == bpt)
13230 {
13231 b->next = bpt->next;
13232 break;
13233 }
13234
13235 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13236 been freed. */
13237 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13238 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13239 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13240 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13241 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13242 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13243 commands won't work. */
13244
13245 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13246
13247 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13248 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13249 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13250 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13251 might be better design to have location completely
13252 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13253 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13254
13255 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13256 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13257 bpt->type = bp_none;
13258 delete bpt;
13259 }
13260
13261 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13262 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13263
13264 static void
13265 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13266 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13267 {
13268 struct breakpoint *related;
13269
13270 related = b;
13271 do
13272 {
13273 struct breakpoint *next;
13274
13275 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13276 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13277
13278 if (next == related)
13279 {
13280 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13281 function (related);
13282
13283 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13284 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13285 out. */
13286 break;
13287 }
13288 else
13289 function (related);
13290
13291 related = next;
13292 }
13293 while (related != b);
13294 }
13295
13296 static void
13297 delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
13298 {
13299 dont_repeat ();
13300
13301 if (arg == 0)
13302 {
13303 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13304
13305 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13306 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13307 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13308 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
13309 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13310 {
13311 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13312 break;
13313 }
13314
13315 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13316 if (!from_tty
13317 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13318 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
13319 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13320 delete_breakpoint (b);
13321 }
13322 else
13323 map_breakpoint_numbers
13324 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
13325 {
13326 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
13327 });
13328 }
13329
13330 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
13331 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
13332 considered. */
13333
13334 static int
13335 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13336 {
13337 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
13338 if ((pspace == NULL
13339 || loc->pspace == pspace)
13340 && !loc->shlib_disabled
13341 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13342 return 0;
13343 return 1;
13344 }
13345
13346 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13347 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13348 Null names are ignored. */
13349
13350 static int
13351 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13352 {
13353 struct bp_location *l;
13354 htab_up htab (htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, htab_eq_string, NULL,
13355 xcalloc, xfree));
13356
13357 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13358 {
13359 const char **slot;
13360 const char *name = l->function_name;
13361
13362 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13363 if (name == NULL)
13364 continue;
13365
13366 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab.get (), (const void *) name,
13367 INSERT);
13368 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13369 returns NULL. */
13370 if (*slot != NULL)
13371 return 1;
13372 *slot = name;
13373 }
13374
13375 return 0;
13376 }
13377
13378 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13379 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13380 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13381 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13382 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13383 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13384 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13385 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13386 The heuristic is:
13387
13388 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13389 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13390 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13391 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13392 in the sources, and output a warning.
13393
13394 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13395 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13396 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13397 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13398 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13399 warning.
13400
13401 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13402 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13403 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13404 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13405 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13406 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13407 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13408 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13409 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13410
13411 static struct symtab_and_line
13412 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13413 {
13414 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13415 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13416 CORE_ADDR pc;
13417
13418 pc = sal.pc;
13419 if (sal.line)
13420 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13421
13422 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13423 {
13424 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id)
13425 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13426 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (),
13427 marker.str_id.c_str ());
13428
13429 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
13430
13431 return sal;
13432 }
13433
13434 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13435 by string ID. */
13436 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13437 && sal.line != 0
13438 && sal.symtab != NULL
13439 && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
13440 {
13441 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
13442 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid
13443 (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13444
13445 if (!markers.empty ())
13446 {
13447 struct symbol *sym;
13448 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13449 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13450 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
13451
13452 tpmarker = &markers[0];
13453
13454 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id);
13455
13456 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13457 "found at previous line number"),
13458 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13459
13460 symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13461 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13462 uiout->text ("Now in ");
13463 if (sym)
13464 {
13465 uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (),
13466 function_name_style.style ());
13467 uiout->text (" at ");
13468 }
13469 uiout->field_string ("file",
13470 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab),
13471 file_name_style.style ());
13472 uiout->text (":");
13473
13474 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
13475 {
13476 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13477
13478 uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
13479 }
13480
13481 uiout->field_signed ("line", sal2.line);
13482 uiout->text ("\n");
13483
13484 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13485 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
13486
13487 b->location.reset (NULL);
13488 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13489 explicit_loc.source_filename
13490 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13491 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
13492 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
13493 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13494
13495 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13496 so. */
13497 }
13498 }
13499 return sal;
13500 }
13501
13502 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13503 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13504
13505 static int
13506 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
13507 {
13508 while (a && b)
13509 {
13510 if (a->address != b->address)
13511 return 0;
13512
13513 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
13514 return 0;
13515
13516 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
13517 return 0;
13518
13519 if (a->disabled_by_cond != b->disabled_by_cond)
13520 return 0;
13521
13522 a = a->next;
13523 b = b->next;
13524 }
13525
13526 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
13527 return 0;
13528
13529 return 1;
13530 }
13531
13532 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
13533 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
13534 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
13535
13536 static struct bp_location *
13537 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13538 {
13539 struct bp_location head;
13540 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
13541 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
13542 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
13543
13544 if (pspace == NULL)
13545 {
13546 i = b->loc;
13547 b->loc = NULL;
13548 return i;
13549 }
13550
13551 head.next = NULL;
13552
13553 while (i != NULL)
13554 {
13555 if (i->pspace == pspace)
13556 {
13557 *i_link = i->next;
13558 i->next = NULL;
13559 hoisted->next = i;
13560 hoisted = i;
13561 }
13562 else
13563 i_link = &i->next;
13564 i = *i_link;
13565 }
13566
13567 return head.next;
13568 }
13569
13570 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
13571 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
13572 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
13573 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
13574 untouched. */
13575
13576 void
13577 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
13578 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
13579 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
13580 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
13581 {
13582 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
13583
13584 if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
13585 {
13586 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13587 location. */
13588 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13589 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13590 "multiple locations found\n"),
13591 b->number);
13592 return;
13593 }
13594
13595 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13596 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13597 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13598 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13599 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13600 individual locations. */
13601 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
13602 return;
13603
13604 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
13605
13606 for (const auto &sal : sals)
13607 {
13608 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13609
13610 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
13611
13612 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
13613
13614 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13615 old symtab. */
13616 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13617 {
13618 const char *s;
13619
13620 s = b->cond_string;
13621 try
13622 {
13623 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
13624 block_for_pc (sal.pc),
13625 0);
13626 }
13627 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
13628 {
13629 new_loc->disabled_by_cond = true;
13630 }
13631 }
13632
13633 if (!sals_end.empty ())
13634 {
13635 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
13636
13637 new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
13638 }
13639 }
13640
13641 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13642 breakpoints. */
13643 {
13644 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13645 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13646 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13647 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13648 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13649 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13650 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13651
13652 for (; e; e = e->next)
13653 {
13654 if ((!e->enabled || e->disabled_by_cond) && e->function_name)
13655 {
13656 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13657 {
13658 for (bp_location *l : b->locations ())
13659 {
13660 /* Ignore software vs hardware location type at
13661 this point, because with "set breakpoint
13662 auto-hw", after a re-set, locations that were
13663 hardware can end up as software, or vice versa.
13664 As mentioned above, this is an heuristic and in
13665 practice should give the correct answer often
13666 enough. */
13667 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l, true))
13668 {
13669 l->enabled = e->enabled;
13670 l->disabled_by_cond = e->disabled_by_cond;
13671 break;
13672 }
13673 }
13674 }
13675 else
13676 {
13677 for (bp_location *l : b->locations ())
13678 if (l->function_name
13679 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
13680 {
13681 l->enabled = e->enabled;
13682 l->disabled_by_cond = e->disabled_by_cond;
13683 break;
13684 }
13685 }
13686 }
13687 }
13688 }
13689
13690 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13691 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13692 }
13693
13694 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13695 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13696
13697 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13698 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
13699 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
13700 {
13701 struct gdb_exception exception;
13702
13703 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13704
13705 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
13706
13707 try
13708 {
13709 sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13710 }
13711 catch (gdb_exception_error &e)
13712 {
13713 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13714
13715 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13716 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13717 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13718 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13719 state, then user already saw the message about that
13720 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13721 errors. */
13722 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13723 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13724 || (b->loc != NULL
13725 && search_pspace != NULL
13726 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
13727 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13728 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13729 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13730 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13731
13732 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13733 {
13734 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13735 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13736 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13737 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13738 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13739 which approach is better. */
13740 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13741 throw;
13742 }
13743
13744 exception = std::move (e);
13745 }
13746
13747 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13748 {
13749 for (auto &sal : sals)
13750 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
13751 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
13752 {
13753 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
13754 int thread, task;
13755
13756 find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (sals, b->extra_string,
13757 &cond_string, &thread,
13758 &task, &extra_string);
13759 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
13760 if (cond_string)
13761 b->cond_string = cond_string;
13762 b->thread = thread;
13763 b->task = task;
13764 if (extra_string)
13765 {
13766 xfree (b->extra_string);
13767 b->extra_string = extra_string;
13768 }
13769 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13770 }
13771
13772 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13773 sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
13774
13775 *found = 1;
13776 }
13777 else
13778 *found = 0;
13779
13780 return sals;
13781 }
13782
13783 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13784 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13785 locations. */
13786
13787 static void
13788 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13789 {
13790 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
13791 std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
13792
13793 int found;
13794 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
13795 filter_pspace, &found);
13796 if (found)
13797 expanded = std::move (sals);
13798
13799 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
13800 {
13801 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
13802 = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
13803 filter_pspace, &found);
13804 if (found)
13805 expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
13806 }
13807
13808 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
13809 }
13810
13811 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13812 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13813
13814 static void
13815 create_sals_from_location_default (struct event_location *location,
13816 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13817 enum bptype type_wanted)
13818 {
13819 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
13820 }
13821
13822 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13823 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13824 breakpoint_ops. */
13825
13826 static void
13827 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13828 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13829 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13830 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13831 enum bptype type_wanted,
13832 enum bpdisp disposition,
13833 int thread,
13834 int task, int ignore_count,
13835 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13836 int from_tty, int enabled,
13837 int internal, unsigned flags)
13838 {
13839 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
13840 std::move (cond_string),
13841 std::move (extra_string),
13842 type_wanted, disposition,
13843 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13844 enabled, internal, flags);
13845 }
13846
13847 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13848 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13849
13850 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13851 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
13852 struct event_location *location,
13853 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13854 {
13855 struct linespec_result canonical;
13856
13857 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
13858 NULL, 0, &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13859 b->filter.get ());
13860
13861 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13862 gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
13863
13864 if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
13865 {
13866 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
13867 return std::move (lsal.sals);
13868 }
13869 return {};
13870 }
13871
13872 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13873
13874 static void
13875 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
13876 {
13877 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13878 set_language (b->language);
13879
13880 b->ops->re_set (b);
13881 }
13882
13883 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13884 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
13885
13886 void
13887 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13888 {
13889 {
13890 scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
13891 scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
13892 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
13893
13894 /* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language
13895 of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context)
13896 before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can
13897 unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set
13898 to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context,
13899 we select the current frame.
13900
13901 We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to
13902 language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints
13903 have been reset. */
13904 scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode);
13905 language_mode = language_mode_manual;
13906
13907 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
13908 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
13909 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
13910 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
13911
13912 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
13913 {
13914 try
13915 {
13916 breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
13917 }
13918 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
13919 {
13920 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
13921 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13922 b->number);
13923 }
13924 }
13925
13926 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13927 }
13928
13929 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13930 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
13931 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
13932 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
13933
13934 /* Now we can insert. */
13935 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
13936 }
13937 \f
13938 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
13939
13940 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
13941 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
13942 void
13943 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
13944 {
13945 if (b->thread != -1)
13946 {
13947 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
13948
13949 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
13950 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
13951 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
13952 as well. */
13953 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
13954 }
13955 }
13956
13957 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
13958 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
13959 which ends with a period (no newline). */
13960
13961 void
13962 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
13963 {
13964 if (count < 0)
13965 count = 0;
13966
13967 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
13968 if (b->number == bptnum)
13969 {
13970 if (is_tracepoint (b))
13971 {
13972 if (from_tty && count != 0)
13973 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
13974 bptnum);
13975 return;
13976 }
13977
13978 b->ignore_count = count;
13979 if (from_tty)
13980 {
13981 if (count == 0)
13982 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
13983 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
13984 bptnum);
13985 else if (count == 1)
13986 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
13987 bptnum);
13988 else
13989 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
13990 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
13991 count, bptnum);
13992 }
13993 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13994 return;
13995 }
13996
13997 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
13998 }
13999
14000 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
14001
14002 static void
14003 ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14004 {
14005 const char *p = args;
14006 int num;
14007
14008 if (p == 0)
14009 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
14010
14011 num = get_number (&p);
14012 if (num == 0)
14013 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
14014 if (*p == 0)
14015 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
14016
14017 set_ignore_count (num,
14018 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14019 from_tty);
14020 if (from_tty)
14021 printf_filtered ("\n");
14022 }
14023 \f
14024
14025 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
14026 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
14027
14028 static void
14029 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
14030 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14031 {
14032 if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
14033 {
14034 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
14035 bp_num_range.first);
14036 }
14037 else
14038 {
14039 for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
14040 {
14041 bool match = false;
14042
14043 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
14044 if (b->number == i)
14045 {
14046 match = true;
14047 function (b);
14048 break;
14049 }
14050 if (!match)
14051 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
14052 }
14053 }
14054 }
14055
14056 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
14057 ARGS. */
14058
14059 static void
14060 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
14061 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14062 {
14063 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14064 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14065
14066 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14067
14068 while (!parser.finished ())
14069 {
14070 int num = parser.get_number ();
14071 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
14072 }
14073 }
14074
14075 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
14076 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
14077
14078 static struct bp_location *
14079 find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
14080 {
14081 breakpoint *b = get_breakpoint (bp_num);
14082
14083 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14084 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
14085
14086 if (loc_num == 0)
14087 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14088
14089 int n = 0;
14090 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
14091 if (++n == loc_num)
14092 return loc;
14093
14094 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14095 }
14096
14097 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
14098 enum class extract_bp_kind
14099 {
14100 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
14101 bp,
14102
14103 /* Extracting a location number. */
14104 loc,
14105 };
14106
14107 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
14108 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
14109 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
14110 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
14111 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
14112
14113 static int
14114 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
14115 int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
14116 {
14117 const char *end = start;
14118 int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
14119 if (num < 0)
14120 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14121 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14122 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14123 int (end - start), start);
14124 if (num == 0)
14125 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14126 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14127 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14128 int (end - start), start);
14129
14130 if (end_out != NULL)
14131 *end_out = end;
14132 return num;
14133 }
14134
14135 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
14136 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
14137 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
14138 are always positive integers. */
14139
14140 static std::pair<int, int>
14141 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
14142 const std::string &arg,
14143 std::string::size_type arg_offset)
14144 {
14145 std::pair<int, int> range;
14146 const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
14147 std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
14148 if (dash != std::string::npos)
14149 {
14150 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
14151 if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
14152 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14153 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
14154 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
14155 bp_loc);
14156
14157 const char *end;
14158 const char *start_first = bp_loc;
14159 const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
14160 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
14161 range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
14162
14163 if (range.first > range.second)
14164 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14165 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
14166 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
14167 int (end - start_first), start_first);
14168 }
14169 else
14170 {
14171 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
14172 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
14173 range.second = range.first;
14174 }
14175 return range;
14176 }
14177
14178 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
14179 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
14180 BP_LOC_RANGE.
14181
14182 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
14183
14184 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
14185 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
14186 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
14187 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
14188 location number range.
14189 */
14190
14191 static void
14192 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
14193 std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
14194 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
14195 {
14196 std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
14197
14198 if (dot != std::string::npos)
14199 {
14200 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
14201
14202 if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
14203 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
14204
14205 bp_num_range.first
14206 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
14207 bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
14208
14209 bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
14210 arg, dot + 1);
14211 }
14212 else
14213 {
14214 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
14215
14216 bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
14217 bp_loc_range.first = 0;
14218 bp_loc_range.second = 0;
14219 }
14220 }
14221
14222 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
14223 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
14224
14225 static void
14226 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
14227 {
14228 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
14229 if (loc != NULL)
14230 {
14231 if (loc->disabled_by_cond && enable)
14232 error (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is invalid at location %d, "
14233 "cannot enable."), bp_num, loc_num);
14234
14235 if (loc->enabled != enable)
14236 {
14237 loc->enabled = enable;
14238 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14239 }
14240 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14241 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14242 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14243 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14244 }
14245 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14246
14247 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (loc->owner);
14248 }
14249
14250 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
14251 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
14252 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
14253 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
14254 location. */
14255
14256 static void
14257 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
14258 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
14259 bool enable)
14260 {
14261 for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
14262 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
14263 }
14264
14265 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14266 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14267 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14268
14269 void
14270 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14271 {
14272 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14273 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14274 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14275 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14276 return;
14277
14278 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14279
14280 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14281 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14282
14283 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14284 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14285 {
14286 for (bp_location *location : bpt->locations ())
14287 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14288 }
14289
14290 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14291
14292 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14293 }
14294
14295 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
14296 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
14297 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
14298 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
14299
14300 static void
14301 enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
14302 {
14303 if (args == 0)
14304 {
14305 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
14306 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14307 {
14308 if (enable)
14309 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14310 else
14311 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14312 }
14313 }
14314 else
14315 {
14316 std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
14317
14318 while (!num.empty ())
14319 {
14320 std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
14321
14322 extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
14323
14324 if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
14325 && bp_loc_range.first == 0)
14326 {
14327 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
14328 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
14329 enable
14330 ? enable_breakpoint
14331 : disable_breakpoint);
14332 }
14333 else
14334 {
14335 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
14336 'x.y-z'. */
14337 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
14338 (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
14339 }
14340 num = extract_arg (&args);
14341 }
14342 }
14343 }
14344
14345 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
14346 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
14347 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
14348 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14349
14350 static void
14351 disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14352 {
14353 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
14354 }
14355
14356 static void
14357 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14358 int count)
14359 {
14360 int target_resources_ok;
14361
14362 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14363 {
14364 int i;
14365 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14366 target_resources_ok =
14367 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14368 i + 1, 0);
14369 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14370 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14371 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14372 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14373 }
14374
14375 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14376 {
14377 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14378 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14379
14380 try
14381 {
14382 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14383
14384 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14385 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14386 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14387 }
14388 catch (const gdb_exception &e)
14389 {
14390 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14391 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14392 bpt->number);
14393 return;
14394 }
14395 }
14396
14397 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14398
14399 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14400 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14401
14402 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14403 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14404 {
14405 for (bp_location *location : bpt->locations ())
14406 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14407 }
14408
14409 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14410 bpt->enable_count = count;
14411 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14412
14413 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14414 }
14415
14416
14417 void
14418 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14419 {
14420 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14421 }
14422
14423 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
14424 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
14425 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
14426 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14427
14428 static void
14429 enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14430 {
14431 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
14432 }
14433
14434 static void
14435 enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14436 {
14437 map_breakpoint_numbers
14438 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14439 {
14440 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14441 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14442 {
14443 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
14444 });
14445 });
14446 }
14447
14448 static void
14449 enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14450 {
14451 int count;
14452
14453 if (args == NULL)
14454 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14455
14456 count = get_number (&args);
14457
14458 map_breakpoint_numbers
14459 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14460 {
14461 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14462 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14463 {
14464 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
14465 });
14466 });
14467 }
14468
14469 static void
14470 enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14471 {
14472 map_breakpoint_numbers
14473 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14474 {
14475 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14476 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14477 {
14478 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
14479 });
14480 });
14481 }
14482 \f
14483 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14484 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14485 GDB itself. */
14486
14487 static void
14488 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14489 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14490 const bfd_byte *data)
14491 {
14492 for (breakpoint *bp : all_breakpoints ())
14493 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14494 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14495 {
14496 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14497
14498 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val != nullptr)
14499 {
14500 for (bp_location *loc : bp->locations ())
14501 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14502 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14503 && addr + len > loc->address)
14504 {
14505 wp->val = NULL;
14506 wp->val_valid = false;
14507 }
14508 }
14509 }
14510 }
14511
14512 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14513
14514 void
14515 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14516 const address_space *aspace,
14517 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14518 {
14519 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14520 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14521 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14522
14523 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14524 {
14525 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14526 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
14527 }
14528
14529 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14530 sal.pc = pc;
14531 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14532 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14533 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14534
14535 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14536 }
14537
14538 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
14539
14540 int
14541 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
14542 {
14543 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
14544 std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
14545
14546 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
14547
14548 if (!next_pcs.empty ())
14549 {
14550 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
14551 const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
14552
14553 for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
14554 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
14555
14556 return 1;
14557 }
14558 else
14559 return 0;
14560 }
14561
14562 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14563
14564 int
14565 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
14566 const address_space *aspace,
14567 CORE_ADDR pc)
14568 {
14569 for (bp_location *loc : bp->locations ())
14570 if (loc->inserted
14571 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
14572 return 1;
14573
14574 return 0;
14575 }
14576
14577 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14578 PC. */
14579
14580 int
14581 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
14582 CORE_ADDR pc)
14583 {
14584 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
14585 {
14586 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14587 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14588 return 1;
14589 }
14590 return 0;
14591 }
14592
14593 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14594
14595 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14596 static void
14597 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14598 {
14599 tracepoint_count = num;
14600 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14601 }
14602
14603 static void
14604 trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14605 {
14606 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14607 current_language);
14608 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
14609 (location.get (), true /* is_tracepoint */);
14610
14611 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14612 location.get (),
14613 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
14614 0 /* tempflag */,
14615 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14616 0 /* Ignore count */,
14617 pending_break_support,
14618 ops,
14619 from_tty,
14620 1 /* enabled */,
14621 0 /* internal */, 0);
14622 }
14623
14624 static void
14625 ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14626 {
14627 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14628 current_language);
14629 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14630 location.get (),
14631 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
14632 0 /* tempflag */,
14633 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14634 0 /* Ignore count */,
14635 pending_break_support,
14636 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14637 from_tty,
14638 1 /* enabled */,
14639 0 /* internal */, 0);
14640 }
14641
14642 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14643
14644 static void
14645 strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14646 {
14647 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14648 event_location_up location;
14649
14650 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14651 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14652 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
14653 {
14654 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14655 location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
14656 }
14657 else
14658 {
14659 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14660 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14661 }
14662
14663 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14664 location.get (),
14665 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
14666 0 /* tempflag */,
14667 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14668 0 /* Ignore count */,
14669 pending_break_support,
14670 ops,
14671 from_tty,
14672 1 /* enabled */,
14673 0 /* internal */, 0);
14674 }
14675
14676 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14677 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14678
14679 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14680 static int next_cmd;
14681
14682 static char *
14683 read_uploaded_action (void)
14684 {
14685 char *rslt = nullptr;
14686
14687 if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ())
14688 {
14689 rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd].get ();
14690 next_cmd++;
14691 }
14692
14693 return rslt;
14694 }
14695
14696 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14697 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14698 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14699 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14700 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14701
14702 struct tracepoint *
14703 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14704 {
14705 const char *addr_str;
14706 char small_buf[100];
14707 struct tracepoint *tp;
14708
14709 if (utp->at_string)
14710 addr_str = utp->at_string.get ();
14711 else
14712 {
14713 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14714 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14715 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14716 user. */
14717 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14718 "source location, using raw address"),
14719 utp->number);
14720 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14721 addr_str = small_buf;
14722 }
14723
14724 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14725 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14726 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14727 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14728 utp->number);
14729
14730 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
14731 current_language);
14732 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14733 location.get (),
14734 utp->cond_string.get (), -1, addr_str,
14735 false /* force_condition */,
14736 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14737 0 /* tempflag */,
14738 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14739 0 /* Ignore count */,
14740 pending_break_support,
14741 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14742 0 /* from_tty */,
14743 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14744 0 /* internal */,
14745 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14746 return NULL;
14747
14748 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14749 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14750 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14751
14752 if (utp->pass > 0)
14753 {
14754 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
14755 tp->number);
14756
14757 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14758 }
14759
14760 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14761 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14762 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14763 function. */
14764 if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ())
14765 {
14766 counted_command_line cmd_list;
14767
14768 this_utp = utp;
14769 next_cmd = 0;
14770
14771 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL);
14772
14773 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
14774 }
14775 else if (!utp->actions.empty ()
14776 || !utp->step_actions.empty ())
14777 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14778 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14779 utp->number);
14780
14781 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14782 tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14783 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14784
14785 return tp;
14786 }
14787
14788 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14789 omitted. */
14790
14791 static void
14792 info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14793 {
14794 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14795 int num_printed;
14796
14797 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_tracepoint);
14798
14799 if (num_printed == 0)
14800 {
14801 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14802 uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14803 else
14804 uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14805 }
14806
14807 default_collect_info ();
14808 }
14809
14810 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14811 Not supported by all targets. */
14812 static void
14813 enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14814 {
14815 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14816 }
14817
14818 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14819 Not supported by all targets. */
14820 static void
14821 disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14822 {
14823 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14824 }
14825
14826 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14827 static void
14828 delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14829 {
14830 dont_repeat ();
14831
14832 if (arg == 0)
14833 {
14834 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14835
14836 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14837 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14838 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14839 argument. */
14840 for (breakpoint *tp : all_tracepoints ())
14841 if (is_tracepoint (tp) && user_breakpoint_p (tp))
14842 {
14843 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14844 break;
14845 }
14846
14847 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14848 if (!from_tty
14849 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14850 {
14851 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
14852 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14853 delete_breakpoint (b);
14854 }
14855 }
14856 else
14857 map_breakpoint_numbers
14858 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
14859 {
14860 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
14861 });
14862 }
14863
14864 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
14865
14866 static void
14867 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
14868 {
14869 tp->pass_count = count;
14870 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (tp);
14871 if (from_tty)
14872 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
14873 tp->number, count);
14874 }
14875
14876 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
14877
14878 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
14879 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
14880 Also accepts special argument "all". */
14881
14882 static void
14883 trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14884 {
14885 struct tracepoint *t1;
14886 ULONGEST count;
14887
14888 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
14889 error (_("passcount command requires an "
14890 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
14891
14892 count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
14893
14894 args = skip_spaces (args);
14895 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
14896 {
14897 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
14898 if (*args)
14899 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
14900
14901 for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ())
14902 {
14903 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14904 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14905 }
14906 }
14907 else if (*args == '\0')
14908 {
14909 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
14910 if (t1)
14911 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14912 }
14913 else
14914 {
14915 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14916 while (!parser.finished ())
14917 {
14918 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
14919 if (t1)
14920 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14921 }
14922 }
14923 }
14924
14925 struct tracepoint *
14926 get_tracepoint (int num)
14927 {
14928 for (breakpoint *t : all_tracepoints ())
14929 if (t->number == num)
14930 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14931
14932 return NULL;
14933 }
14934
14935 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
14936 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
14937 reconnecting). */
14938
14939 struct tracepoint *
14940 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
14941 {
14942 for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ())
14943 {
14944 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14945
14946 if (t->number_on_target == num)
14947 return t;
14948 }
14949
14950 return NULL;
14951 }
14952
14953 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
14954 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
14955 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
14956 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
14957
14958 struct tracepoint *
14959 get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg,
14960 number_or_range_parser *parser)
14961 {
14962 int tpnum;
14963 const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
14964
14965 if (parser != NULL)
14966 {
14967 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
14968 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
14969 }
14970 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
14971 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
14972 else
14973 tpnum = get_number (arg);
14974
14975 if (tpnum <= 0)
14976 {
14977 if (instring && *instring)
14978 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
14979 instring);
14980 else
14981 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
14982 return NULL;
14983 }
14984
14985 for (breakpoint *t : all_tracepoints ())
14986 if (t->number == tpnum)
14987 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14988
14989 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
14990 return NULL;
14991 }
14992
14993 void
14994 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
14995 {
14996 if (b->thread != -1)
14997 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
14998
14999 if (b->task != 0)
15000 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15001
15002 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15003 }
15004
15005 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15006 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15007 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15008 true. */
15009
15010 static void
15011 save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
15012 bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15013 {
15014 int any = 0;
15015 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15016
15017 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15018 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15019
15020 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15021 for (breakpoint *tp : all_breakpoints ())
15022 {
15023 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15024 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15025 continue;
15026
15027 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15028 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15029 continue;
15030
15031 any = 1;
15032
15033 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15034 {
15035 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15036
15037 /* We can stop searching. */
15038 break;
15039 }
15040 }
15041
15042 if (!any)
15043 {
15044 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15045 return;
15046 }
15047
15048 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
15049
15050 stdio_file fp;
15051
15052 if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
15053 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15054 expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
15055
15056 if (extra_trace_bits)
15057 save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
15058
15059 for (breakpoint *tp : all_breakpoints ())
15060 {
15061 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15062 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15063 continue;
15064
15065 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15066 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15067 continue;
15068
15069 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
15070
15071 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15072 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15073 instead. */
15074
15075 if (tp->cond_string)
15076 fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15077
15078 if (tp->ignore_count)
15079 fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15080
15081 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15082 {
15083 fp.puts (" commands\n");
15084
15085 current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
15086 try
15087 {
15088 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
15089 }
15090 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
15091 {
15092 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15093 throw;
15094 }
15095
15096 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15097 fp.puts (" end\n");
15098 }
15099
15100 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15101 fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
15102
15103 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15104 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15105 special, and not user visible. */
15106 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15107 {
15108 int n = 1;
15109
15110 for (bp_location *loc : tp->locations ())
15111 {
15112 if (!loc->enabled)
15113 fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15114
15115 n++;
15116 }
15117 }
15118 }
15119
15120 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15121 fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15122
15123 if (from_tty)
15124 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
15125 }
15126
15127 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15128
15129 static void
15130 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15131 {
15132 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15133 }
15134
15135 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15136
15137 static void
15138 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15139 {
15140 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15141 }
15142
15143 \f
15144 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15145 locations used by several commands. */
15146
15147 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15148 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15149 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15150 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15151 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15152 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15153 \n\
15154 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15155 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15156 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15157 \n\
15158 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15159 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15160 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15161 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15162 -function fact -label the_top\".\n\
15163 \n\
15164 By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
15165 functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
15166 classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
15167 \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
15168 \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
15169 specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead."
15170
15171 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15172 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15173 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15174 command. */
15175
15176 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15177 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM]\n\
15178 \t[-force-condition] [if CONDITION]\n\
15179 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15180 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15181 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15182 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15183 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15184 below.\n\
15185 \n\
15186 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15187 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15188 \n\
15189 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15190 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15191 \n\
15192 With the \"-force-condition\" flag, the condition is defined even when\n\
15193 it is invalid for all current locations.\n\
15194 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15195 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15196 conditions are different.\n\
15197 \n\
15198 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15199
15200 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15201 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15202
15203 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15204 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15205
15206 void
15207 add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
15208 cmd_const_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15209 completer_ftype *completer,
15210 void *user_data_catch,
15211 void *user_data_tcatch)
15212 {
15213 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15214
15215 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15216 &catch_cmdlist);
15217 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15218 command->set_context (user_data_catch);
15219 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15220
15221 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15222 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15223 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15224 command->set_context (user_data_tcatch);
15225 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15226 }
15227
15228 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15229 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15230
15231 static int
15232 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15233 {
15234 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15235 non-inline function. */
15236 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15237 return 1;
15238
15239 return 0;
15240 }
15241
15242 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15243 have been inlined. */
15244
15245 int
15246 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15247 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15248 {
15249 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
15250 {
15251 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15252 continue;
15253
15254 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
15255 {
15256 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15257 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15258 return 1;
15259 }
15260 }
15261
15262 return 0;
15263 }
15264
15265 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15266
15267 void
15268 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15269 {
15270 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
15271 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15272 loc->symtab = NULL;
15273 }
15274
15275 void
15276 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15277 {
15278 static int initialized = 0;
15279
15280 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15281
15282 if (initialized)
15283 return;
15284 initialized = 1;
15285
15286 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15287 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15288 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15289 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15290 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15291 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15292 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15293 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15294 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15295 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15296 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15297 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15298
15299 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15300 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15301 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15302 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15303 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15304 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15305 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15306 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15307
15308 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15309 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15310 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15311 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15312 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15313 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15314 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15315 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15316 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15317 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15318
15319 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15320 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15321 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15322 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15323 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15324 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15325 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15326
15327 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15328 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15329 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15330 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15331 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15332 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15333 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15334
15335 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15336 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15337 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15338 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15339 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15340 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15341 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15342
15343 /* Watchpoints. */
15344 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15345 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15346 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15347 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15348 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15349 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15350 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15351 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15352 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15353 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15354 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15355 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15356 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15357
15358 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15359 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15360 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15361 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15362 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15363 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15364 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15365 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15366 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15367 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15368 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15369
15370 /* Tracepoints. */
15371 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15372 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15373 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15374 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15375 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15376 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15377 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15378 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15379 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15380 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15381
15382 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15383 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15384 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15385 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15386 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15387
15388 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15389 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15390 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15391 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15392 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15393 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15394
15395 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15396 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15397 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15398 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15399 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15400 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15401 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15402 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15403 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15404 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15405
15406 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15407 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15408 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15409 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15410 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15411 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15412 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15413 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15414 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15415 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15416
15417 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15418 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15419 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15420 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15421 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15422 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15423 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15424 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15425 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15426 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15427
15428 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15429 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15430 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15431 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15432 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15433 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15434 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15435 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15436 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15437 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15438 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15439
15440 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15441 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15442 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15443 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15444 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15445 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15446 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15447 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15448 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15449 }
15450
15451 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15452
15453 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15454
15455 /* See breakpoint.h. */
15456
15457 cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr;
15458
15459 void _initialize_breakpoint ();
15460 void
15461 _initialize_breakpoint ()
15462 {
15463 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15464
15465 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15466
15467 gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib,
15468 "breakpoint");
15469 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile,
15470 "breakpoint");
15471 gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change,
15472 "breakpoint");
15473
15474 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15475 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15476 before a breakpoint is set. */
15477 breakpoint_count = 0;
15478
15479 tracepoint_count = 0;
15480
15481 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15482 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15483 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15484
15485 commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint,
15486 commands_command, _("\
15487 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
15488 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15489 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
15490 (e.g. `5-7').\n\
15491 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15492 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15493 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15494 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15495 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15496
15497 const auto cc_opts = make_condition_command_options_def_group (nullptr);
15498 static std::string condition_command_help
15499 = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
15500 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15501 Usage is `condition [OPTION] N COND', where N is an integer and COND\n\
15502 is an expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached.\n\
15503 \n\
15504 Options:\n\
15505 %OPTIONS%"), cc_opts);
15506
15507 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command,
15508 condition_command_help.c_str ());
15509 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, condition_completer);
15510
15511 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15512 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15513 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15514 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15515 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15516 \n"
15517 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15518 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15519
15520 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15521 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15522 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15523 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15524 \n"
15525 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15526 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15527
15528 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15529 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15530 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15531 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15532 \n"
15533 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15534 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15535
15536 cmd_list_element *enable_cmd
15537 = add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15538 Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15539 Usage: enable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15540 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15541 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15542 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15543 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15544 &enablelist, 1, &cmdlist);
15545
15546 add_com_alias ("en", enable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15547
15548 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15549 Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15550 Usage: enable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15551 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15552 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15553 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\"."),
15554 &enablebreaklist, 1, &enablelist);
15555
15556 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15557 Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
15558 Usage: enable breakpoints once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15559 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15560 &enablebreaklist);
15561
15562 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15563 Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
15564 Usage: enable breakpoints delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15565 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15566 &enablebreaklist);
15567
15568 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15569 Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
15570 Usage: enable breakpoints count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15571 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15572 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15573 &enablebreaklist);
15574
15575 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15576 Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
15577 Usage: enable delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15578 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15579 &enablelist);
15580
15581 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15582 Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
15583 Usage: enable once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15584 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15585 &enablelist);
15586
15587 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15588 Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
15589 Usage: enable count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15590 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15591 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15592 &enablelist);
15593
15594 cmd_list_element *disable_cmd
15595 = add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15596 Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15597 Usage: disable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15598 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15599 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15600 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15601 &disablelist, 1, &cmdlist);
15602 add_com_alias ("dis", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15603 add_com_alias ("disa", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15604
15605 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15606 Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15607 Usage: disable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15608 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15609 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15610 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15611 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15612 &disablelist);
15613
15614 cmd_list_element *delete_cmd
15615 = add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15616 Delete all or some breakpoints.\n\
15617 Usage: delete [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15618 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15619 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15620 \n\
15621 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects."),
15622 &deletelist, 1, &cmdlist);
15623 add_com_alias ("d", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15624 add_com_alias ("del", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15625
15626 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15627 Delete all or some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15628 Usage: delete breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15629 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15630 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15631 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15632 &deletelist);
15633
15634 cmd_list_element *clear_cmd
15635 = add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15636 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15637 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15638 \n\
15639 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15640 is executing in.\n"
15641 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15642 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15643 add_com_alias ("cl", clear_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15644
15645 cmd_list_element *break_cmd
15646 = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15647 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15648 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15649 set_cmd_completer (break_cmd, location_completer);
15650
15651 add_com_alias ("b", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15652 add_com_alias ("br", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15653 add_com_alias ("bre", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15654 add_com_alias ("brea", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15655
15656 if (dbx_commands)
15657 {
15658 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
15659 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15660 &stoplist, 1, &cmdlist);
15661 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
15662 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
15663 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
15664 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
15665 add_com ("status", class_info, info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15666 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15667 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15668 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15669 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15670 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15671 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15672 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15673 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15674 \n\
15675 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15676 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15677 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15678 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15679 breakpoint set."));
15680 }
15681
15682 cmd_list_element *info_breakpoints_cmd
15683 = add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15684 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15685 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15686 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15687 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15688 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15689 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15690 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15691 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15692 \n\
15693 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15694 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15695 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15696 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15697 breakpoint set."));
15698
15699 add_info_alias ("b", info_breakpoints_cmd, 1);
15700
15701 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15702 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15703 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15704 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15705 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15706 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15707 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15708 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15709 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15710 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15711 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15712 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15713 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15714 \n\
15715 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15716 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15717 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15718 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15719 breakpoint set."),
15720 &maintenanceinfolist);
15721
15722 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, _("\
15723 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15724 &catch_cmdlist,
15725 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15726
15727 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, _("\
15728 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15729 &tcatch_cmdlist,
15730 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15731
15732 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15733 catch_fork_command_1,
15734 NULL,
15735 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
15736 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
15737 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15738 catch_fork_command_1,
15739 NULL,
15740 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
15741 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
15742 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15743 catch_exec_command_1,
15744 NULL,
15745 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15746 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15747 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15748 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15749 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15750 catch_load_command_1,
15751 NULL,
15752 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15753 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15754 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15755 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15756 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15757 catch_unload_command_1,
15758 NULL,
15759 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15760 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15761
15762 const auto opts = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr);
15763
15764 static const std::string watch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
15765 Set a watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\
15766 Usage: watch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15767 \n\
15768 Options:\n\
15769 %OPTIONS%\n\
15770 \n\
15771 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15772 an expression changes."), opts);
15773 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command,
15774 watch_help.c_str ());
15775 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer);
15776
15777 static const std::string rwatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
15778 Set a read watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\
15779 Usage: rwatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15780 \n\
15781 Options:\n\
15782 %OPTIONS%\n\
15783 \n\
15784 A read watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15785 an expression is read."), opts);
15786 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command,
15787 rwatch_help.c_str ());
15788 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer);
15789
15790 static const std::string awatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
15791 Set an access watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\
15792 Usage: awatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15793 \n\
15794 Options:\n\
15795 %OPTIONS%\n\
15796 \n\
15797 An access watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value\n\
15798 of an expression is either read or written."), opts);
15799 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command,
15800 awatch_help.c_str ());
15801 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer);
15802
15803 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
15804 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15805
15806 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15807 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15808 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
15809 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
15810 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15811 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15812 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15813 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15814 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15815 hardware.)"),
15816 NULL,
15817 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
15818 &setlist, &showlist);
15819
15820 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
15821
15822 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15823
15824 cmd_list_element *trace_cmd
15825 = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
15826 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15827 \n"
15828 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15829 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15830 set_cmd_completer (trace_cmd, location_completer);
15831
15832 add_com_alias ("tp", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 0);
15833 add_com_alias ("tr", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15834 add_com_alias ("tra", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15835 add_com_alias ("trac", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15836
15837 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
15838 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15839 \n"
15840 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15841 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15842 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15843
15844 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
15845 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15846 \n\
15847 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15848 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15849 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15850 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15851 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15852 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15853 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15854 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15855 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15856 \n\
15857 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15858 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15859 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15860 conditions are different.\n\
15861 \n\
15862 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
15863 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15864 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15865
15866 cmd_list_element *info_tracepoints_cmd
15867 = add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
15868 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
15869 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
15870 last tracepoint set."));
15871
15872 add_info_alias ("tp", info_tracepoints_cmd, 1);
15873
15874 cmd_list_element *delete_tracepoints_cmd
15875 = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
15876 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
15877 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15878 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
15879 &deletelist);
15880 add_alias_cmd ("tr", delete_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
15881
15882 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
15883 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
15884 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15885 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
15886 &disablelist);
15887 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
15888
15889 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
15890 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
15891 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15892 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
15893 &enablelist);
15894 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
15895
15896 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
15897 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
15898 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
15899 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
15900 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
15901
15902 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint,
15903 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
15904 &save_cmdlist,
15905 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15906
15907 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
15908 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
15909 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
15910 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
15911 session to restore them."),
15912 &save_cmdlist);
15913 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15914
15915 cmd_list_element *save_tracepoints_cmd
15916 = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
15917 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
15918 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
15919 &save_cmdlist);
15920 set_cmd_completer (save_tracepoints_cmd, filename_completer);
15921
15922 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", save_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 0);
15923 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
15924
15925 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, _("\
15926 Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
15927 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15928 pending breakpoint behavior."),
15929 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15930 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
15931 add_show_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, _("\
15932 Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
15933 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15934 pending breakpoint behavior."),
15935 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist,
15936 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
15937
15938 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
15939 &pending_break_support, _("\
15940 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15941 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15942 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
15943 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
15944 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
15945 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
15946 NULL,
15947 show_pending_break_support,
15948 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15949 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15950
15951 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
15952
15953 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
15954 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
15955 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15956 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15957 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
15958 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
15959 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
15960 NULL,
15961 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
15962 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15963 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15964
15965 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
15966 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
15967 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15968 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15969 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
15970 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
15971 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
15972 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
15973 when execution stops."),
15974 NULL,
15975 &show_always_inserted_mode,
15976 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15977 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15978
15979 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
15980 condition_evaluation_enums,
15981 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
15982 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15983 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15984 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
15985 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
15986 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
15987 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
15988 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
15989 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
15990 be set to \"host\"."),
15991 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
15992 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
15993 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15994 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15995
15996 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
15997 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
15998 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
15999 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16000 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16001 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16002 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16003 or the start of the range\n\
16004 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16005 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16006 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16007 \n\
16008 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16009 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16010 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16011
16012 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16013 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
16014 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16015 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
16016 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
16017 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16018
16019 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16020 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16021 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16022 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16023 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16024 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16025 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16026 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16027 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16028 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16029 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16030 &setlist, &showlist);
16031
16032 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16033 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16034 &dprintf_function, _("\
16035 Set the function to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
16036 Show the function to use for dynamic printf."), NULL,
16037 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16038 &setlist, &showlist);
16039
16040 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16041 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16042 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16043 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
16044 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf."), NULL,
16045 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16046 &setlist, &showlist);
16047
16048 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16049 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16050 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16051 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16052 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16053 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16054 NULL,
16055 NULL,
16056 &setlist, &showlist);
16057
16058 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16059 Target agent only formatted printing, like the C \"printf\" function.\n\
16060 Usage: agent-printf \"format string\", ARG1, ARG2, ARG3, ..., ARGN\n\
16061 This supports most C printf format specifications, like %s, %d, etc.\n\
16062 This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16063
16064 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = true;
16065
16066 gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed,
16067 "breakpoint");
16068 gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints,
16069 "breakpoint");
16070 }
This page took 0.375584 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.